]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - ld/ld.texi
Revert ld ASCII support
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @setfilename ld.info
3 @c Copyright (C) 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @syncodeindex ky cp
5 @c man begin INCLUDE
6 @include configdoc.texi
7 @c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8 @include bfdver.texi
9 @c man end
10
11 @c @smallbook
12
13 @macro gcctabopt{body}
14 @code{\body\}
15 @end macro
16
17 @c man begin NAME
18 @ifset man
19 @c Configure for the generation of man pages
20 @set UsesEnvVars
21 @set GENERIC
22 @set ARM
23 @set C6X
24 @set CSKY
25 @set H8300
26 @set HPPA
27 @set M68HC11
28 @set M68K
29 @set MIPS
30 @set MMIX
31 @set MSP430
32 @set NDS32
33 @set NIOSII
34 @set PDP11
35 @set POWERPC
36 @set POWERPC64
37 @set Renesas
38 @set S/390
39 @set SPU
40 @set TICOFF
41 @set WIN32
42 @set XTENSA
43 @end ifset
44 @c man end
45
46 @ifnottex
47 @dircategory Software development
48 @direntry
49 * Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
50 @end direntry
51 @end ifnottex
52
53 @copying
54 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57 @end ifset
58 version @value{VERSION}.
59
60 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
67 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68 @end copying
69 @iftex
70 @finalout
71 @setchapternewpage odd
72 @settitle The GNU linker
73 @titlepage
74 @title The GNU linker
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @code{ld}
77 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79 @end ifset
80 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81 @author Steve Chamberlain
82 @author Ian Lance Taylor
83 @page
84
85 @tex
86 {\parskip=0pt
87 \hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88 \hfill nickc\@redhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89 \hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90 \hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91 }
92 \global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
104 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105 @c man end
106
107 @end titlepage
108 @end iftex
109 @contents
110 @c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top
114 @top LD
115 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118 @end ifset
119 version @value{VERSION}.
120
121 This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122 Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123 in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125 @menu
126 * Overview:: Overview
127 * Invocation:: Invocation
128 * Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129 * Plugins:: Linker Plugins
130 @ifset GENERIC
131 * Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132 @end ifset
133 @ifclear GENERIC
134 @ifset H8300
135 * H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136 @end ifset
137 @ifset Renesas
138 * Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
139 @end ifset
140 @ifset ARM
141 * ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142 @end ifset
143 @ifset M68HC11
144 * M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145 @end ifset
146 @ifset HPPA
147 * HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148 @end ifset
149 @ifset M68K
150 * M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151 @end ifset
152 @ifset MIPS
153 * MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154 @end ifset
155 @ifset POWERPC
156 * PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157 @end ifset
158 @ifset POWERPC64
159 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160 @end ifset
161 @ifset S/390
162 * S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163 @end ifset
164 @ifset SPU
165 * SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166 @end ifset
167 @ifset TICOFF
168 * TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169 @end ifset
170 @ifset WIN32
171 * Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172 @end ifset
173 @ifset XTENSA
174 * Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175 @end ifset
176 @end ifclear
177 @ifclear SingleFormat
178 * BFD:: BFD
179 @end ifclear
180 @c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182 * Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183 * MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
184 * GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
185 * LD Index:: LD Index
186 @end menu
187 @end ifnottex
188
189 @node Overview
190 @chapter Overview
191
192 @cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193 @cindex what is this?
194
195 @ifset man
196 @c man begin SYNOPSIS
197 ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
198 @c man end
199
200 @c man begin SEEALSO
201 ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202 the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203 @file{ld}.
204 @c man end
205 @end ifset
206
207 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
209 @command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
210 their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
211 compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
212
213 @command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
214 a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215 to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
217 @ifset man
218 @c For the man only
219 This man page does not describe the command language; see the
220 @command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221 language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
222 @end ifset
223
224 @ifclear SingleFormat
225 This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226 to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
227 write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228 @code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229 available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230 @end ifclear
231
232 Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233 linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234 execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
235 @command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
236 (or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
238 @c man end
239
240 @node Invocation
241 @chapter Invocation
242
243 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
245 The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
246 and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247 you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
249 @c man end
250
251 @ifset UsesEnvVars
252 @menu
253 * Options:: Command-line Options
254 * Environment:: Environment Variables
255 @end menu
256
257 @node Options
258 @section Command-line Options
259 @end ifset
260
261 @cindex command line
262 @cindex options
263
264 @c man begin OPTIONS
265
266 The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267 practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268 @cindex standard Unix system
269 For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
270 object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271 link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273 @smallexample
274 ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275 @end smallexample
276
277 This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
278 result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279 the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280 directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
282 Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
283 point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284 as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285 which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286 files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287 different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
288 occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289 option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290 noted in the descriptions below.
291
292 @cindex object files
293 Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294 together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295 options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296 an option and its argument.
297
298 Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299 specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300 and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301 are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302 message @samp{No input files}.
303
304 If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
305 assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306 augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307 linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308 permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309 or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
310 @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311 script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312 extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313 to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314 the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
315
316 For options whose names are a single letter,
317 option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318 whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319 option that requires them.
320
321 For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
322 precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
323 @samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
324 this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
325 only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
326 @samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327 name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328 output.
329
330 Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331 option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332 immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333 @samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334 Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335 accepted.
336
337 Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
338 (e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
339 prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340 compiler driver) like this:
341
342 @smallexample
343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
344 @end smallexample
345
346 This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
347 silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348 may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349 driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350 a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351 and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352 the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354 @smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356 @end smallexample
357
358 Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
359 linker:
360
361 @table @gcctabopt
362 @include at-file.texi
363
364 @kindex -a @var{keyword}
365 @item -a @var{keyword}
366 This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367 argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368 @samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369 @samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370 to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
372 @kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373 @item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378 finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
379 it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
380 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
381 interface.
382
383 @ifclear SingleFormat
384 @cindex binary input format
385 @kindex -b @var{format}
386 @kindex --format=@var{format}
387 @cindex input format
388 @cindex input format
389 @item -b @var{input-format}
390 @itemx --format=@var{input-format}
391 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
393 @samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
394 that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
395 configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
396 to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
397 default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398 @var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399 supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400 formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401 @xref{BFD}.
402
403 You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404 binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405 linking object files of different formats), by including
406 @samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
407 particular format.
408
409 The default format is taken from the environment variable
410 @code{GNUTARGET}.
411 @ifset UsesEnvVars
412 @xref{Environment}.
413 @end ifset
414 You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
415 @code{TARGET};
416 @ifclear man
417 see @ref{Format Commands}.
418 @end ifclear
419 @end ifclear
420
421 @kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422 @kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423 @cindex compatibility, MRI
424 @item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425 @itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
426 For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
427 files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
428 @ifclear man
429 @ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430 @end ifclear
431 @ifset man
432 the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433 @end ifset
434 Introduce MRI script files with
435 the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
436 scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437 If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
438 specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440 @cindex common allocation
441 @kindex -d
442 @kindex -dc
443 @kindex -dp
444 @item -d
445 @itemx -dc
446 @itemx -dp
447 These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448 compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449 even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450 script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
453 @kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454 @kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455 @item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456 @itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461 option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
462 The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
463
464 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466 This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467 fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468 section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469 error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470 several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471 section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472 sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474 @smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493 @end smallexample
494
495 This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496 the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500 This option enables warnings when
501 @code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502 matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503 discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504 output region.
505
506 @cindex entry point, from command line
507 @kindex -e @var{entry}
508 @kindex --entry=@var{entry}
509 @item -e @var{entry}
510 @itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511 Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512 program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513 named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514 and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515 base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516 @samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517 and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
519 @kindex --exclude-libs
520 @item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521 Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
522 exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
523 @code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524 automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525 port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526 explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527 option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528 be treated as hidden.
529
530 @kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532 Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533 should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534 into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535 may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536 used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537 the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538 match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539 command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540 of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541 regardless of this option.
542
543 @cindex dynamic symbol table
544 @kindex -E
545 @kindex --export-dynamic
546 @kindex --no-export-dynamic
547 @item -E
548 @itemx --export-dynamic
549 @itemx --no-export-dynamic
550 When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551 option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552 all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553 set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555 If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556 @option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557 dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558 referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
559
560 If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561 back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562 dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563 linking the program itself.
564
565 You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
566 be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
567 See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
568
569 Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570 support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571 the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
573 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574 @cindex export dynamic symbol
575 @item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576 When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577 @var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578 shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579 bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580 no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581 @samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582 on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585 @cindex export dynamic symbol list
586 @item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587 Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588 The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
591 @ifclear SingleFormat
592 @cindex big-endian objects
593 @cindex endianness
594 @kindex -EB
595 @item -EB
596 Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598 @cindex little-endian objects
599 @kindex -EL
600 @item -EL
601 Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
602 @end ifclear
603
604 @kindex -f @var{name}
605 @kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606 @item -f @var{name}
607 @itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
608 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609 to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610 table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611 symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615 the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616 first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617 @var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618 in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619 Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620 implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
621 machine-specific performance.
622
623 This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624 will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
626 @kindex -F @var{name}
627 @kindex --filter=@var{name}
628 @item -F @var{name}
629 @itemx --filter=@var{name}
630 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631 the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632 of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633 on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637 dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638 filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639 found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640 used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641 @var{name}.
642
643 Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
644 toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
645 object files.
646 @ifclear SingleFormat
647 The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
648 @option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
649 @code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
650 environment variable.
651 @end ifclear
652 The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653 creating an ELF shared object.
654
655 @cindex finalization function
656 @kindex -fini=@var{name}
657 @item -fini=@var{name}
658 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659 executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660 address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661 the function to call.
662
663 @kindex -g
664 @item -g
665 Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
667 @kindex -G @var{value}
668 @kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
669 @cindex object size
670 @item -G @var{value}
671 @itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672 Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673 @var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
674 MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
675 sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677 @cindex runtime library name
678 @kindex -h @var{name}
679 @kindex -soname=@var{name}
680 @item -h @var{name}
681 @itemx -soname=@var{name}
682 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683 the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684 which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685 linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686 field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
687
688 @kindex -i
689 @cindex incremental link
690 @item -i
691 Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
693 @cindex initialization function
694 @kindex -init=@var{name}
695 @item -init=@var{name}
696 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697 executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698 of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699 function to call.
700
701 @cindex archive files, from cmd line
702 @kindex -l @var{namespec}
703 @kindex --library=@var{namespec}
704 @item -l @var{namespec}
705 @itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706 Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707 list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708 If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
709 will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
710 will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
711
712 On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
713 files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714 and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715 called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716 @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717 indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718 to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719 @var{filename}.
720
721 The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722 specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723 was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724 command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725 archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726 the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
728 See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
729 archives multiple times.
730
731 You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733 @ifset GENERIC
734 This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
735 if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
736 behaviour of the AIX linker.
737 @end ifset
738
739 @cindex search directory, from cmd line
740 @kindex -L @var{dir}
741 @kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
742 @item -L @var{searchdir}
743 @itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
744 Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745 for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
746 option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747 in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748 on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
749 @option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
750 order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751 how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752 option is specified.
753
754 If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755 prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756 @samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
757
758 @ifset UsesEnvVars
759 The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
760 @samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
761 some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762 @end ifset
763
764 The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765 @code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766 at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768 @cindex emulation
769 @kindex -m @var{emulation}
770 @item -m @var{emulation}
771 Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772 emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774 If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775 @code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777 Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778 configured.
779
780 @cindex link map
781 @kindex -M
782 @kindex --print-map
783 @item -M
784 @itemx --print-map
785 Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786 information about the link, including the following:
787
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 Where object files are mapped into memory.
791 @item
792 How common symbols are allocated.
793 @item
794 All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795 which caused the archive member to be brought in.
796 @item
797 The values assigned to symbols.
798
799 Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800 involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801 have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802 linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803 of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804 the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805 linker script containing:
806
807 @smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811 @end smallexample
812
813 will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814 option is used:
815
816 @smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820 @end smallexample
821
822 See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823 scripts.
824
825 @item
826 How GNU properties are merged.
827
828 When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829 .note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830 These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
831
832 @smallexample
833 Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834 @end smallexample
835
836 This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
837 merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840 @smallexample
841 Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
842 @end smallexample
843
844 This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
845 when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
847 @end itemize
848
849 @cindex link map discarded
850 @kindex --print-map-discarded
851 @kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852 @item --print-map-discarded
853 @itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854 Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855 in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
857 @kindex -n
858 @cindex read-only text
859 @cindex NMAGIC
860 @kindex --nmagic
861 @item -n
862 @itemx --nmagic
863 Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865 mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
866
867 @kindex -N
868 @kindex --omagic
869 @cindex read/write from cmd line
870 @cindex OMAGIC
871 @item -N
872 @itemx --omagic
873 Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
874 not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
876 mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877 is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878 specification published by Microsoft.
879
880 @kindex --no-omagic
881 @cindex OMAGIC
882 @item --no-omagic
883 This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884 sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885 be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886 shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
887
888 @kindex -o @var{output}
889 @kindex --output=@var{output}
890 @cindex naming the output file
891 @item -o @var{output}
892 @itemx --output=@var{output}
893 Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
894 option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895 script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
897 @kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898 @cindex dependency file
899 @item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900 Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901 suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902 that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903 output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904 Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905 Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906 to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907 linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908 @samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909 installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910 distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
912 @kindex -O @var{level}
913 @cindex generating optimized output
914 @item -O @var{level}
915 If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
916 the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
917 should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918 option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919 the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920 no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921 of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
922
923 @kindex -plugin @var{name}
924 @item -plugin @var{name}
925 Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926 the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927 automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928 optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929 wish.
930
931 Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932 from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933 @command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934 those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
935 copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
936 based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
937 just copy in the newest one.
938
939 @kindex --push-state
940 @cindex push state governing input file handling
941 @item --push-state
942 The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
943 flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944 restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946 The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947 @option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948 @option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949 @option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950 @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951 @option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953 One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954 used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955 listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956 something as follows:
957
958 @smallexample
959 -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960 @end smallexample
961
962 @kindex --pop-state
963 @cindex pop state governing input file handling
964 @item --pop-state
965 Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966 flags governing input file handling.
967
968 @kindex -q
969 @kindex --emit-relocs
970 @cindex retain relocations in final executable
971 @item -q
972 @itemx --emit-relocs
973 Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
974 Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975 order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976 in larger executables.
977
978 This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
980 @kindex --force-dynamic
981 @cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982 @item --force-dynamic
983 Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984 to VxWorks targets.
985
986 @cindex partial link
987 @cindex relocatable output
988 @kindex -r
989 @kindex --relocatable
990 @item -r
991 @itemx --relocatable
992 Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
993 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
994 linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995 magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996 @code{OMAGIC}.
997 @c ; see @option{-N}.
998 If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999 linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000 constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
1002 When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003 partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004 relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005 example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006 with input files in other formats at all.
1007
1008 This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010 @kindex -R @var{file}
1011 @kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012 @cindex symbol-only input
1013 @item -R @var{filename}
1014 @itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015 Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016 relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017 to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018 programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
1020 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1021 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1022 the @option{-rpath} option.
1023
1024 @kindex -s
1025 @kindex --strip-all
1026 @cindex strip all symbols
1027 @item -s
1028 @itemx --strip-all
1029 Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031 @kindex -S
1032 @kindex --strip-debug
1033 @cindex strip debugger symbols
1034 @item -S
1035 @itemx --strip-debug
1036 Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
1038 @kindex --strip-discarded
1039 @kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040 @item --strip-discarded
1041 @itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042 Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043 Enabled by default.
1044
1045 @kindex -t
1046 @kindex --trace
1047 @cindex input files, displaying
1048 @item -t
1049 @itemx --trace
1050 Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051 @samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052 @samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053 and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054 a linker bug report.
1055
1056 @kindex -T @var{script}
1057 @kindex --script=@var{script}
1058 @cindex script files
1059 @item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060 @itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061 Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
1062 @command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
1063 @var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1064 output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065 the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066 specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067 options accumulate.
1068
1069 @kindex -dT @var{script}
1070 @kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071 @cindex script files
1072 @item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073 @itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074 Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076 This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077 processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078 command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079 @option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080 behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081 command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082 the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083 @samp{gcc}).
1084
1085 @kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086 @kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087 @cindex undefined symbol
1088 @item -u @var{symbol}
1089 @itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092 modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093 different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094 option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
1096 If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097 into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098 undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099 instead.
1100
1101 @kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102 @cindex symbols, require defined
1103 @cindex defined symbol
1104 @item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105 Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106 is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107 is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108 and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109 @code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110 can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
1112 @kindex -Ur
1113 @cindex constructors
1114 @item -Ur
1115 For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116 @samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
1117 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
1118 @emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119 It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120 with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121 be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122 @samp{-r} for the others.
1123
1124 @kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125 @cindex orphan sections
1126 @cindex sections, orphan
1127 @item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128 Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129 specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131 @var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133 @table @code
1134 @item place
1135 Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136 the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
1137 @samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1138
1139 @item discard
1140 All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141 @samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143 @item warn
1144 The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145 issue a warning.
1146
1147 @item error
1148 The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149 @end table
1150
1151 The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
1153 @kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154 @item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155 Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156 @var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157 missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158 specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159 multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160 input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161 in a linker script.
1162
1163 @kindex -v
1164 @kindex -V
1165 @kindex --version
1166 @cindex version
1167 @item -v
1168 @itemx --version
1169 @itemx -V
1170 Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
1171 lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173 @kindex -x
1174 @kindex --discard-all
1175 @cindex deleting local symbols
1176 @item -x
1177 @itemx --discard-all
1178 Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180 @kindex -X
1181 @kindex --discard-locals
1182 @cindex local symbols, deleting
1183 @item -X
1184 @itemx --discard-locals
1185 Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186 system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187 or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1188
1189 @kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190 @kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191 @cindex symbol tracing
1192 @item -y @var{symbol}
1193 @itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194 Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195 option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196 to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198 This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199 don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201 @kindex -Y @var{path}
1202 @item -Y @var{path}
1203 Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204 for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206 @kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207 @item -z @var{keyword}
1208 The recognized keywords are:
1209 @table @samp
1210
1211 @item call-nop=prefix-addr
1212 @itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1213 @itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1214 @itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1215 Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1216 to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1217 @option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1218 @option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1219 @option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1220 @option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1221 Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1222
1223 @item cet-report=none
1224 @itemx cet-report=warning
1225 @itemx cet-report=error
1226 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1227 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1228 section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1229 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1230 @option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1231 missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1232 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1233 Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1234 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1235 turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1236 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1237
1238 @item combreloc
1239 @itemx nocombreloc
1240 Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1241 dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1242
1243 @item common
1244 @itemx nocommon
1245 Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1246 link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1247
1248 @item common-page-size=@var{value}
1249 Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1250 layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1251 using pages of this size.
1252
1253 @item defs
1254 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1255 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1256 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1257
1258 @item dynamic-undefined-weak
1259 @itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1260 Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1261 if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1262 by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1263 @samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1264 may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1265 selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1266 these options.
1267
1268 @item execstack
1269 Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1270
1271 @item global
1272 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1273 the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1274 of subsequently loaded libraries.
1275
1276 @item globalaudit
1277 This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1278 This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1279 setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1280 tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1281 the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1282 all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1283
1284 @item ibtplt
1285 Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1286 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1287
1288 @item ibt
1289 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1290 to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1291 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1292
1293 @item indirect-extern-access
1294 @itemx noindirect-extern-access
1295 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1296 .note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1297 canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1298 This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1299 @option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1300
1301 @option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1302 GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1303 section.
1304
1305 @item initfirst
1306 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1307 It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1308 before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1309 the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1310 the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1311 objects.
1312
1313 @item interpose
1314 Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1315 so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1316 libraries not so marked.
1317
1318 @item unique
1319 @itemx nounique
1320 When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1321 object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1322 and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1323 primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1324 al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1325 of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1326 and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1327
1328 @item lam-u48
1329 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1330 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1331
1332 @item lam-u57
1333 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1334 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1335
1336 @item lam-u48-report=none
1337 @itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1338 @itemx lam-u48-report=error
1339 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1340 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1341 @option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1342 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1343 @option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1344 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1345 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1346 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1347
1348 @item lam-u57-report=none
1349 @itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1350 @itemx lam-u57-report=error
1351 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1352 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1353 @option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1354 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1355 @option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1356 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1357 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1358 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1359
1360 @item lam-report=none
1361 @itemx lam-report=warning
1362 @itemx lam-report=error
1363 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1364 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1365 section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1366 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1367 @option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1368 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1369 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1370 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1371
1372 @item lazy
1373 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1374 dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1375 the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1376 Lazy binding is the default.
1377
1378 @item loadfltr
1379 Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1380
1381 @item max-page-size=@var{value}
1382 Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1383
1384 @item muldefs
1385 Allow multiple definitions.
1386
1387 @item nocopyreloc
1388 Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1389 defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
1390
1391 @item nodefaultlib
1392 Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1393 should ignore any default library search paths.
1394
1395 @item nodelete
1396 Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1397
1398 @item nodlopen
1399 Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1400
1401 @item nodump
1402 Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1403
1404 @item noexecstack
1405 Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1406
1407 @item noextern-protected-data
1408 Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1409 library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1410 used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1411 generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1412 module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1413 i386 and x86-64.
1414
1415 @item noreloc-overflow
1416 Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1417 relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1418 overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
1419
1420 @item now
1421 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1422 dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1423 when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1424 function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1425 called.
1426
1427 @item origin
1428 Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1429
1430 @item pack-relative-relocs
1431 @itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1432 Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1433 and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1434 @code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1435 building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1436 @option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
1437 relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1438 GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1439 added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1440
1441 @item relro
1442 @itemx norelro
1443 Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1444 specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1445 relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1446 than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1447 Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1448
1449 @item report-relative-reloc
1450 Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1451 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1452
1453 @item separate-code
1454 @itemx noseparate-code
1455 Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1456 specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1457 be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1458 code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1459
1460 @item shstk
1461 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1462 to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1463 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1464
1465 @item stack-size=@var{value}
1466 Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1467 Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1468 @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1469
1470 @item start-stop-gc
1471 @itemx nostart-stop-gc
1472 @cindex start-stop-gc
1473 When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1474 section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1475 input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1476 @code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1477 @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1478 linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1479 sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1480 were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1481 definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1482 object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1483 linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1484 @code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1485 treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1486
1487 @item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1488 @cindex visibility
1489 @cindex ELF symbol visibility
1490 Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1491 @code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1492 Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1493 @samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1494 start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1495 compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1496 recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1497 programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1498 between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1499
1500 @item text
1501 @itemx notext
1502 @itemx textoff
1503 Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1504 or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1505 report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1506
1507 @item undefs
1508 Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1509 either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1510 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1511
1512 @item unique-symbol
1513 @itemx nounique-symbol
1514 Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1515 ".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1516 is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1517
1518 @item x86-64-baseline
1519 @item x86-64-v2
1520 @item x86-64-v3
1521 @itemx x86-64-v4
1522 Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1523 @option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
1524 @option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1525 @option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1526 @option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1527 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1528
1529 @end table
1530
1531 Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1532
1533 @kindex -(
1534 @cindex groups of archives
1535 @item -( @var{archives} -)
1536 @itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1537 The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1538 either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1539
1540 The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1541 references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1542 the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1543 archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1544 object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1545 would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
1546 they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1547 resolved.
1548
1549 Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1550 it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1551 more archives.
1552
1553 @kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1554 @kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1555 @item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1556 @itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1557 Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1558 recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1559 and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1560 the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1561 behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1562 so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1563 restore the old behaviour.
1564
1565 @kindex --as-needed
1566 @kindex --no-as-needed
1567 @item --as-needed
1568 @itemx --no-as-needed
1569 This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1570 on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
1571 the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1572 on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1573 needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1574 emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1575 non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1576 the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1577 non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1578 Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1579 the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1580 needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1581 from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1582
1583 Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1584 an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1585 @option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1586 @option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1587
1588 @kindex --add-needed
1589 @kindex --no-add-needed
1590 @item --add-needed
1591 @itemx --no-add-needed
1592 These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1593 their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1594 options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1595 and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1596
1597 @kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1598 @item -assert @var{keyword}
1599 This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1600
1601 @kindex -Bdynamic
1602 @kindex -dy
1603 @kindex -call_shared
1604 @item -Bdynamic
1605 @itemx -dy
1606 @itemx -call_shared
1607 Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1608 for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1609 default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1610 for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1611 multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1612 @option{-l} options which follow it.
1613
1614 @kindex -Bgroup
1615 @item -Bgroup
1616 Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1617 section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1618 object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1619 @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1620 only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1621
1622 @kindex -Bstatic
1623 @kindex -dn
1624 @kindex -non_shared
1625 @kindex -static
1626 @item -Bstatic
1627 @itemx -dn
1628 @itemx -non_shared
1629 @itemx -static
1630 Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1631 platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1632 variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1633 may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1634 library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
1635 option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1636 option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1637 shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1638 references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1639 libraries.
1640
1641 @kindex -Bsymbolic
1642 @item -Bsymbolic
1643 When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1644 definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1645 for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1646 within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1647 platforms which support shared libraries.
1648
1649 @kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1650 @item -Bsymbolic-functions
1651 When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1652 symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1653 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1654 libraries.
1655
1656 @kindex -Bno-symbolic
1657 @item -Bno-symbolic
1658 This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1659 @samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1660
1661 @kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1662 @item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1663 Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1664 typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1665 global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1666 within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1667 to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1668 in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1669 which support shared libraries.
1670
1671 The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1672 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1673
1674 @kindex --dynamic-list-data
1675 @item --dynamic-list-data
1676 Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1677
1678 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1679 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1680 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1681 is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1682
1683 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1684 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1685 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1686
1687 @kindex --check-sections
1688 @kindex --no-check-sections
1689 @item --check-sections
1690 @itemx --no-check-sections
1691 Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1692 been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
1693 perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1694 suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1695 allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
1696 restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1697 Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1698 force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1699 option.
1700
1701 @kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1702 @kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1703 @item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1704 @itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1705 This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1706 by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1707 command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1708 output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1709 input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1710 specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1711 follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1712 behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1713
1714 This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1715 libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1716 mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1717 their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1718 required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1719 the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1720 dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1721 symbols.
1722
1723 @cindex cross reference table
1724 @kindex --cref
1725 @item --cref
1726 Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1727 generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1728 Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1729
1730 The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1731 easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1732 sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1733 symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1734 definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1735 where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1736 symbol are listed.
1737
1738 @cindex ctf variables
1739 @kindex --ctf-variables
1740 @kindex --no-ctf-variables
1741 @item --ctf-variables
1742 @item --no-ctf-variables
1743 The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1744 types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1745 table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1746 conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1747 usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1748 @option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1749 The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1750
1751 @cindex ctf type sharing
1752 @kindex --ctf-share-types
1753 @item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1754 Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1755
1756 @table @samp
1757 @item share-unconflicted
1758 Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1759 where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1760 translation unit. This is the default.
1761
1762 @item share-duplicated
1763 Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1764 dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1765 dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1766 always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1767 larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1768 large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1769 consumer at runtime.
1770 @end table
1771
1772 @cindex common allocation
1773 @kindex --no-define-common
1774 @item --no-define-common
1775 This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1776 The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1777 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1778
1779 The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1780 the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1781 of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1782 forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1783 Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1784 from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1785 This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1786 and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1787 duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1788 paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1789
1790 @cindex group allocation in linker script
1791 @cindex section groups
1792 @cindex COMDAT
1793 @kindex --force-group-allocation
1794 @item --force-group-allocation
1795 This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1796 normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1797 default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1798 change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1799 command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1800 effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1801
1802 @cindex symbols, from command line
1803 @kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1804 @item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1805 Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1806 address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1807 times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1808 limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1809 context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1810 symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1811 constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1812 using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1813 @emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1814 equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1815
1816 The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1817 in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1818 symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1819 placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1820 the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1821 consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1822 @samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1823 you are trying to achieve.
1824
1825 @cindex demangling, from command line
1826 @kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1827 @kindex --no-demangle
1828 @item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1829 @itemx --no-demangle
1830 These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1831 and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1832 present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1833 underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1834 mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1835 different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1836 to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
1837 demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1838 is set. These options may be used to override the default.
1839
1840 @cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1841 @kindex -I@var{file}
1842 @kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1843 @item -I@var{file}
1844 @itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1845 Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1846 generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1847 linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1848 doing.
1849
1850 @kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1851 @item --no-dynamic-linker
1852 When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1853 linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1854 executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1855 entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1856
1857 @kindex --embedded-relocs
1858 @item --embedded-relocs
1859 This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1860 that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
1861 is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1862 targets.
1863
1864 @kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1865 @item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1866 Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1867 in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1868
1869 @kindex --fatal-warnings
1870 @kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1871 @item --fatal-warnings
1872 @itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1873 Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1874 with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1875
1876 @kindex -w
1877 @kindex --no-warnings
1878 @item -w
1879 @itemx --no-warnings
1880 Do not display any warning or error messages. This overrides
1881 @option{--fatal-warnings} if it has been enabled. This option can be
1882 used when it is known that the output binary will not work, but there
1883 is still a need to create it.
1884
1885 @kindex --force-exe-suffix
1886 @item --force-exe-suffix
1887 Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1888
1889 If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1890 @code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1891 the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1892 option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1893 Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1894 it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1895
1896 @kindex --gc-sections
1897 @kindex --no-gc-sections
1898 @cindex garbage collection
1899 @item --gc-sections
1900 @itemx --no-gc-sections
1901 Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
1902 targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
1903 performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
1904 @samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1905 collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1906 implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
1907
1908 @samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1909 examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1910 symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1911 command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1912 referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1913 libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1914 referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1915 the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
1916 relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1917 @samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
1918
1919 This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
1920 @samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
1921 specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1922 @samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1923 command in the linker script.
1924
1925 As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1926 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1927
1928 @kindex --print-gc-sections
1929 @kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1930 @cindex garbage collection
1931 @item --print-gc-sections
1932 @itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1933 List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1934 printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1935 collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1936 default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1937 be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1938 line.
1939
1940 @kindex --gc-keep-exported
1941 @cindex garbage collection
1942 @item --gc-keep-exported
1943 When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1944 collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1945 default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1946 executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1947 collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1948 Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1949 it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1950 ELF format targets.
1951
1952 @kindex --print-output-format
1953 @cindex output format
1954 @item --print-output-format
1955 Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1956 other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1957 in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1958
1959 @kindex --print-memory-usage
1960 @cindex memory usage
1961 @item --print-memory-usage
1962 Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1963 the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1964 quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1965 headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1966 parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1967
1968 @smallexample
1969 Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1970 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1971 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1972 @end smallexample
1973
1974 @cindex help
1975 @cindex usage
1976 @kindex --help
1977 @item --help
1978 Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1979
1980 @kindex --target-help
1981 @item --target-help
1982 Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
1983
1984 @kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1985 @item -Map=@var{mapfile}
1986 Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
1987 @option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1988 @code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1989
1990 Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1991 written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1992 inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1993 file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1994 @code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1995 output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1996 @var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1997
1998 @smallexample
1999 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2000 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2001 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2002 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2003 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
2004 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2005 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2006 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2007 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2008 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2009 @end smallexample
2010
2011 It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2012
2013 If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2014 operation.
2015
2016 @cindex memory usage
2017 @kindex --no-keep-memory
2018 @item --no-keep-memory
2019 @command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2020 symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
2021 instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
2022 necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
2023 while linking a large executable.
2024
2025 @kindex --no-undefined
2026 @kindex -z defs
2027 @kindex -z undefs
2028 @item --no-undefined
2029 @itemx -z defs
2030 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2031 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2032 The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2033 behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
2034 libraries being linked in.
2035
2036 The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2037
2038 @kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2039 @kindex -z muldefs
2040 @item --allow-multiple-definition
2041 @itemx -z muldefs
2042 Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2043 report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2044 first definition will be used.
2045
2046 @kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
2047 @kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2048 @item --allow-shlib-undefined
2049 @itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2050 Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
2051 This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2052 determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2053 shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2054 how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2055
2056 The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2057 referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2058 an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2059 a shared library.
2060
2061 The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2062 libraries specified at link time are that:
2063
2064 @itemize @bullet
2065 @item
2066 A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2067 that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2068 resolvable at load time.
2069 @item
2070 There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2071 symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2072
2073 The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2074 select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2075 architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2076 appropriate memset function.
2077 @end itemize
2078
2079 @kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2080 @item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2081 If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2082 @var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2083 only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2084 libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
2085 ``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2086 undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2087 will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
2088 might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2089 error message will be displayed.
2090
2091 The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2092 switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2093
2094 @kindex --no-undefined-version
2095 @item --no-undefined-version
2096 Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2097 it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2098 will be issued instead.
2099
2100 @kindex --default-symver
2101 @item --default-symver
2102 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2103 exported symbols.
2104
2105 @kindex --default-imported-symver
2106 @item --default-imported-symver
2107 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2108 imported symbols.
2109
2110 @kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2111 @item --no-warn-mismatch
2112 Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
2113 files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2114 been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
2115 This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
2116 errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2117 have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2118 inappropriate.
2119
2120 @kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2121 @item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2122 Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2123 library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2124
2125 @kindex --no-whole-archive
2126 @item --no-whole-archive
2127 Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
2128 archive files.
2129
2130 @cindex output file after errors
2131 @kindex --noinhibit-exec
2132 @item --noinhibit-exec
2133 Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2134 Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2135 errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2136 when it issues any error whatsoever.
2137
2138 @kindex -nostdlib
2139 @item -nostdlib
2140 Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2141 command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2142 (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2143
2144 @ifclear SingleFormat
2145 @kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2146 @item --oformat=@var{output-format}
2147 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2148 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
2149 @samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
2150 object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2151 object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
2152 should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2153 usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2154 name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2155 list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2156 command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2157 this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2158 @end ifclear
2159
2160 @kindex --out-implib
2161 @item --out-implib @var{file}
2162 Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2163 the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2164 library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2165 may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2166 behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2167 step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2168 the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2169
2170 @kindex -pie
2171 @kindex --pic-executable
2172 @item -pie
2173 @itemx --pic-executable
2174 @cindex position independent executables
2175 Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2176 ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2177 libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
2178 address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
2179 normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2180 defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2181
2182 @kindex -no-pie
2183 @item -no-pie
2184 @cindex position dependent executables
2185 Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2186
2187 @kindex -qmagic
2188 @item -qmagic
2189 This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2190
2191 @kindex -Qy
2192 @item -Qy
2193 This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2194
2195 @kindex --relax
2196 @cindex synthesizing linker
2197 @cindex relaxing addressing modes
2198 @cindex --no-relax
2199 @item --relax
2200 @itemx --no-relax
2201 An option with machine dependent effects.
2202 @ifset GENERIC
2203 This option is only supported on a few targets.
2204 @end ifset
2205 @ifset H8300
2206 @xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2207 @end ifset
2208 @ifset XTENSA
2209 @xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2210 @end ifset
2211 @ifset M68HC11
2212 @xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2213 @end ifset
2214 @ifset NIOSII
2215 @xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2216 @end ifset
2217 @ifset POWERPC
2218 @xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2219 @end ifset
2220
2221 On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2222 global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2223 addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2224 synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2225 instructions, and combining constant values.
2226
2227 On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2228 debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2229 @ifset GENERIC
2230 This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2231 family of processors.
2232 @end ifset
2233
2234 On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2235 @option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2236
2237 On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2238 and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2239
2240 @cindex retaining specified symbols
2241 @cindex stripping all but some symbols
2242 @cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2243 @kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2244 @item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2245 Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2246 discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2247 symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2248 @ifset GENERIC
2249 (such as VxWorks)
2250 @end ifset
2251 where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2252 run-time memory.
2253
2254 @samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2255 or symbols needed for relocations.
2256
2257 You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2258 line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2259
2260 @ifset GENERIC
2261 @item -rpath=@var{dir}
2262 @cindex runtime library search path
2263 @kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2264 Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
2265 linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
2266 arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2267 them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2268
2269 The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2270 are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2271 description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2272 in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2273 have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2274
2275 If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2276 contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2277 is defined.
2278
2279 The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
2280 SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2281 @option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2282 runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2283 options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2284 gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2285 file systems.
2286
2287 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2288 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2289 the @option{-rpath} option.
2290 @end ifset
2291
2292 @ifset GENERIC
2293 @cindex link-time runtime library search path
2294 @kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2295 @item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2296 When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2297 happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2298 of the input files.
2299
2300 When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2301 non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2302 shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2303 explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2304 specifies the first set of directories to search. The
2305 @option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2306 either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2307 appearing multiple times.
2308
2309 The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2310 directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2311 containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2312 and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
2313 64-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2314
2315 The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2316 @var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2317 supported.
2318
2319 This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2320 that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2321 is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2322 runtime linker would do.
2323
2324 The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2325 libraries:
2326
2327 @enumerate
2328 @item
2329 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2330 @item
2331 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2332 between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2333 specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2334 used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2335 at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2336 by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2337 the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2338 @item
2339 On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2340 @option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2341 environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2342 @item
2343 On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2344 directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2345 @item
2346 For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2347 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2348 @item
2349 For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2350 @code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2351 libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2352 @code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2353 @item
2354 For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2355 exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2356 to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2357 defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2358 configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2359 @item
2360 For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2361 the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2362 header file.
2363 @item
2364 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2365 linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2366 by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2367 @item
2368 The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2369 @item
2370 Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2371 @item
2372 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2373 linker script.
2374 @end enumerate
2375
2376 Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2377 the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2378 is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2379 library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2380 @emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2381 directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2382 this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2383 @file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2384 of the first.
2385
2386 If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2387 warning and continue with the link.
2388
2389 @end ifset
2390
2391 @kindex -shared
2392 @kindex -Bshareable
2393 @item -shared
2394 @itemx -Bshareable
2395 @cindex shared libraries
2396 Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2397 and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2398 shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2399 undefined symbols in the link.
2400
2401 @kindex --sort-common
2402 @item --sort-common
2403 @itemx --sort-common=ascending
2404 @itemx --sort-common=descending
2405 This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2406 ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2407 sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2408 eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2409 between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2410 specified, then descending order is assumed.
2411
2412 @kindex --sort-section=name
2413 @item --sort-section=name
2414 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2415 patterns in the linker script.
2416
2417 @kindex --sort-section=alignment
2418 @item --sort-section=alignment
2419 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2420 patterns in the linker script.
2421
2422 @kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2423 @item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2424 This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2425 .dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2426 post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2427
2428 @kindex --split-by-file
2429 @item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2430 Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2431 each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2432 size of 1 if not given.
2433
2434 @kindex --split-by-reloc
2435 @item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2436 Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2437 output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2438 This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2439 certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2440 cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2441 that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2442 support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2443 input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2444 more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2445 many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2446
2447 @kindex --stats
2448 @item --stats
2449 Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2450 as execution time and memory usage.
2451
2452 @kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2453 @item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2454 Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2455 configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2456 that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2457
2458 @kindex --task-link
2459 @item --task-link
2460 This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2461 file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2462
2463 @kindex --traditional-format
2464 @cindex traditional format
2465 @item --traditional-format
2466 For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2467 the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
2468 use the traditional format instead.
2469
2470 @cindex dbx
2471 For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2472 symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2473 full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2474 @code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2475 trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2476 combine duplicate entries.
2477
2478 @kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2479 @item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2480 Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2481 address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2482 times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2483 line.
2484 @var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2485 for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2486 @samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2487 should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2488 sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2489
2490 @kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2491 @kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2492 @kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2493 @cindex segment origins, cmd line
2494 @item -Tbss=@var{org}
2495 @itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2496 @itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2497 Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2498 @code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2499
2500 @kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2501 @item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2502 @cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2503 When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2504 byte of the text segment.
2505
2506 @kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2507 @item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2508 @cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2509 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2510 the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2511 text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2512
2513 @kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2514 @item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2515 @cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2516 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2517 model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2518
2519 @kindex --unresolved-symbols
2520 @item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2521 Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2522 values for @samp{method}:
2523
2524 @table @samp
2525 @item ignore-all
2526 Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2527
2528 @item report-all
2529 Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
2530
2531 @item ignore-in-object-files
2532 Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2533 ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2534
2535 @item ignore-in-shared-libs
2536 Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2537 ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2538 when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2539 libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2540 command line.
2541 @end table
2542
2543 The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2544 by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2545
2546 Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2547 unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2548 can change this to a warning.
2549
2550 @kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2551 @cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2552 @item --dll-verbose
2553 @itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2554 Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2555 supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
2556 the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2557 argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2558
2559 @kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2560 @cindex version script, symbol versions
2561 @item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2562 Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2563 used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2564 about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
2565 is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2566 see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2567 use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2568 symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2569 @xref{WIN32}.
2570
2571 @kindex --warn-common
2572 @cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2573 @cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2574 @item --warn-common
2575 Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2576 a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2577 but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2578 you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2579 Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2580 warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2581
2582 There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2583
2584 @table @samp
2585 @item int i = 1;
2586 A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2587 file.
2588
2589 @item extern int i;
2590 An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2591 There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2592 variable somewhere.
2593
2594 @item int i;
2595 A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2596 variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2597 The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2598 single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2599 size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2600 a definition of the same variable.
2601 @end table
2602
2603 The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2604 Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2605 just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2606 encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2607 a common symbol.
2608
2609 @enumerate
2610 @item
2611 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2612 definition for the symbol.
2613 @smallexample
2614 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2615 overridden by definition
2616 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2617 @end smallexample
2618
2619 @item
2620 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2621 the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2622 except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2623 @smallexample
2624 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2625 overriding common
2626 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2627 @end smallexample
2628
2629 @item
2630 Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2631 @smallexample
2632 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2633 of `@var{symbol}'
2634 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2635 @end smallexample
2636
2637 @item
2638 Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2639 @smallexample
2640 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2641 overridden by larger common
2642 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2643 @end smallexample
2644
2645 @item
2646 Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2647 the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2648 encountered in a different order.
2649 @smallexample
2650 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2651 overriding smaller common
2652 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2653 @end smallexample
2654 @end enumerate
2655
2656 @kindex --warn-constructors
2657 @item --warn-constructors
2658 Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2659 object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2660 detect the use of global constructors.
2661
2662 @kindex --warn-execstack
2663 @cindex warnings, on executable stack
2664 @cindex executable stack, warnings on
2665 @item --warn-execstack
2666 @itemx --no-warn-execstack
2667 On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning
2668 messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack. By
2669 default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command
2670 line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the
2671 @option{--warn-execstack} option.
2672
2673 On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made
2674 executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable
2675 stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z
2676 noexecstack} command line options have been specified. This warning
2677 can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option.
2678
2679 Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable
2680 stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2681 bit set in its section flags. They can specify that they do not need
2682 an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable
2683 flag bit set. If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack}
2684 section present then the default behaviour is target specific. For
2685 some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an
2686 executable stack @emph{is} required. This is often a problem for hand
2687 crafted assembler files.
2688
2689 @kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2690 @item --warn-multiple-gp
2691 Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2692 This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2693 Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2694 section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2695 of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2696 base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2697 base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2698 bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2699 large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2700 values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2701 option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2702
2703 @kindex --warn-once
2704 @cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2705 @cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2706 @item --warn-once
2707 Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2708 which refers to it.
2709
2710 @kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2711 @cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2712 @cindex executable segments, warnings on
2713 @item --warn-rwx-segments
2714 @itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2715 Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2716 all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set. Such a
2717 segment represents a potential security vulnerability. In addition
2718 warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2719 created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2720 not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2721
2722 These warnings are enabled by default. They can be disabled via the
2723 @option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2724 @option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2725
2726 @kindex --warn-section-align
2727 @cindex warnings, on section alignment
2728 @cindex section alignment, warnings on
2729 @item --warn-section-align
2730 Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2731 alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2732 The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2733 is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2734 the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2735
2736 @kindex --warn-textrel
2737 @item --warn-textrel
2738 Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2739 or shared object.
2740
2741 @kindex --warn-alternate-em
2742 @item --warn-alternate-em
2743 Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2744
2745 @kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2746 @item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2747 If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2748 @option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2749 This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2750
2751 @kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2752 @item --error-unresolved-symbols
2753 This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2754 it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2755
2756 @kindex --whole-archive
2757 @cindex including an entire archive
2758 @item --whole-archive
2759 For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2760 @option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2761 in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2762 files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2763 library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2764 library. This option may be used more than once.
2765
2766 Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2767 about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2768 Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2769 list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2770 your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2771
2772 @kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2773 @item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2774 Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2775 @var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2776 undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2777 @var{symbol}.
2778
2779 This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2780 wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2781 wishes to call the system function, it should call
2782 @code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2783
2784 Here is a trivial example:
2785
2786 @smallexample
2787 void *
2788 __wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2789 @{
2790 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2791 return __real_malloc (c);
2792 @}
2793 @end smallexample
2794
2795 If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2796 all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2797 instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2798 call the real @code{malloc} function.
2799
2800 You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2801 links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
2802 you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2803 file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2804 call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2805
2806 Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2807 internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2808 @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2809 @code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2810
2811 @smallexample
2812 int
2813 f (void)
2814 @{
2815 return 123;
2816 @}
2817
2818 int
2819 g (void)
2820 @{
2821 return f();
2822 @}
2823 @end smallexample
2824
2825 @kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2826 @kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2827 @item --eh-frame-hdr
2828 @itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2829 Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2830 (@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2831 section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2832
2833 @kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2834 @item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2835 Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2836 generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2837 if linker generated unwind info is supported. This option also
2838 controls the generation of @code{.sframe} stack trace info for linker
2839 generated code sections like PLT.
2840
2841 @kindex --enable-new-dtags
2842 @kindex --disable-new-dtags
2843 @item --enable-new-dtags
2844 @itemx --disable-new-dtags
2845 This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2846 systems may not understand them. If you specify
2847 @option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2848 and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
2849 If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
2850 created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2851 those options are only available for ELF systems.
2852
2853 @kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
2854 @item --hash-size=@var{number}
2855 Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2856 close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2857 time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2858 increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2859 value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2860
2861 @kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2862 @item --hash-style=@var{style}
2863 Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2864 @code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2865 new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2866 the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
2867 hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2868 but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
2869
2870 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2871 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2872 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2873 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2874 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zstd
2875 @item --compress-debug-sections=none
2876 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2877 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2878 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2879 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zstd
2880 On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2881 compressed using zlib.
2882
2883 @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2884 sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2885 DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2886 instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2887 also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2888 sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2889
2890 The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2891 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2892
2893 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zstd} compresses DWARF debug sections using
2894 zstd.
2895
2896 Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2897 sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2898 for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2899 uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2900
2901 The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2902 involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2903 default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2904 @option{--help} option.
2905
2906 @kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2907 @item --reduce-memory-overheads
2908 This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
2909 linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
2910 for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2911 about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2912
2913 Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2914 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
2915 run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2916 has been used.
2917
2918 The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2919 enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
2920
2921 @kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2922 @item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2923 @command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
2924 of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
2925 maximum cache size to @var{size}.
2926
2927 @kindex --build-id
2928 @kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2929 @item --build-id
2930 @itemx --build-id=@var{style}
2931 Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
2932 or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
2933 unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2934 @code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2935 @sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2936 @code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2937 the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2938 string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2939 @code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2940 is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
2941
2942 The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2943 that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2944 unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2945 to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2946 file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2947 string identifying the original linked file does not change.
2948
2949 Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2950 @code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
2951
2952 @kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
2953 @item --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
2954 Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section. The
2955 contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata
2956 specification. For more information see:
2957 https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/
2958 If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the
2959 creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier
2960 occurrence of the --package-metdata option.
2961 If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string
2962 will be validated.
2963 @end table
2964
2965 @c man end
2966
2967 @subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
2968
2969 @c man begin OPTIONS
2970
2971 The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
2972 the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2973 normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2974 use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2975 @code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2976 like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2977 symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2978 object file).
2979
2980 In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
2981 support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
2982 PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2983 values by either a space or an equals sign.
2984
2985 @table @gcctabopt
2986
2987 @kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2988 @item --add-stdcall-alias
2989 If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2990 as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
2991 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2992
2993 @kindex --base-file
2994 @item --base-file @var{file}
2995 Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2996 addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2997 @file{dlltool}.
2998 [This is an i386 PE specific option]
2999
3000 @kindex --dll
3001 @item --dll
3002 Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
3003 @option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
3004 file.
3005 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3006
3007 @kindex --enable-long-section-names
3008 @kindex --disable-long-section-names
3009 @item --enable-long-section-names
3010 @itemx --disable-long-section-names
3011 The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
3012 the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
3013 for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
3014 fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
3015 to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
3016 allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
3017 disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
3018 generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
3019 as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
3020 with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
3021 GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3022 information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
3023 option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
3024 section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3025 when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3026 image and not stripping symbols.
3027 [This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3028
3029 @kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3030 @kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3031 @item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3032 @itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3033 If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
3034 do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
3035 only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3036 resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
3037 undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3038 @code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3039 to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
3040 warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3041 import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
3042 to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
3043 feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
3044 @option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
3045 mismatches are considered to be errors.
3046 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3047
3048 @kindex --leading-underscore
3049 @kindex --no-leading-underscore
3050 @item --leading-underscore
3051 @itemx --no-leading-underscore
3052 For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3053 in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3054 disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3055
3056 @cindex DLLs, creating
3057 @kindex --export-all-symbols
3058 @item --export-all-symbols
3059 If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3060 be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
3061 otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
3062 explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3063 attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3064 option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
3065 @code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
3066 @code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
3067 exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3068 re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3069 such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3070 @code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
3071 @code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3072 Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3073 not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
3074 extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
3075 (obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
3076 These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3077 @code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3078 @code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
3079 @code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
3080 @code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
3081 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3082
3083 @kindex --exclude-symbols
3084 @item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
3085 Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3086 exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
3087 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3088
3089 @kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3090 @item --exclude-all-symbols
3091 Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3092 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3093
3094 @kindex --file-alignment
3095 @item --file-alignment
3096 Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3097 file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3098 512.
3099 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3100
3101 @cindex heap size
3102 @kindex --heap
3103 @item --heap @var{reserve}
3104 @itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3105 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3106 to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
3107 committed.
3108 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3109
3110 @cindex image base
3111 @kindex --image-base
3112 @item --image-base @var{value}
3113 Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3114 the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3115 is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3116 your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3117 other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3118 for dlls.
3119 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3120
3121 @kindex --kill-at
3122 @item --kill-at
3123 If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3124 symbols before they are exported.
3125 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3126
3127 @kindex --large-address-aware
3128 @item --large-address-aware
3129 If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
3130 header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
3131 greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
3132 or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3133 section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3134 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3135
3136 @kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3137 @item --disable-large-address-aware
3138 Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3139 This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3140 driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3141 addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3142 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3143
3144 @kindex --major-image-version
3145 @item --major-image-version @var{value}
3146 Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
3147 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3148
3149 @kindex --major-os-version
3150 @item --major-os-version @var{value}
3151 Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
3152 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3153
3154 @kindex --major-subsystem-version
3155 @item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
3156 Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
3157 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3158
3159 @kindex --minor-image-version
3160 @item --minor-image-version @var{value}
3161 Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
3162 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3163
3164 @kindex --minor-os-version
3165 @item --minor-os-version @var{value}
3166 Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
3167 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3168
3169 @kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3170 @item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
3171 Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
3172 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3173
3174 @cindex DEF files, creating
3175 @cindex DLLs, creating
3176 @kindex --output-def
3177 @item --output-def @var{file}
3178 The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3179 file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3180 (which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3181 library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3182 automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
3183 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3184
3185 @cindex DLLs, creating
3186 @kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3187 @item --enable-auto-image-base
3188 @itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3189 Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3190 @var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3191 By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3192 for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3193 execution are avoided.
3194 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3195
3196 @kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3197 @item --disable-auto-image-base
3198 Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3199 user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3200 default.
3201 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3202
3203 @cindex DLLs, linking to
3204 @kindex --dll-search-prefix
3205 @item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
3206 When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
3207 search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
3208 @code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
3209 between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3210 uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
3211 @code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
3212 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3213
3214 @kindex --enable-auto-import
3215 @item --enable-auto-import
3216 Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
3217 DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3218 mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3219 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3220
3221 The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3222 feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3223
3224 Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3225 of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3226 PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
3227
3228 Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3229 data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3230 placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3231 around a problem with consts that is described here:
3232 http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3233
3234 Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3235 see this message:
3236
3237 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
3238 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3239
3240 This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3241 ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
3242 allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3243 fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3244 constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
3245 multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3246 this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3247 of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3248 the warning, and exit.
3249
3250 There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3251 data type of the exported variable:
3252
3253 One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3254 of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
3255 this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
3256
3257 A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3258 that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3259 there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
3260 a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3261
3262 @example
3263 extern type extern_array[];
3264 extern_array[1] -->
3265 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3266 @end example
3267
3268 or
3269
3270 @example
3271 extern type extern_array[];
3272 extern_array[1] -->
3273 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3274 @end example
3275
3276 For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3277 is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3278
3279 @example
3280 extern struct s extern_struct;
3281 extern_struct.field -->
3282 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3283 @end example
3284
3285 or
3286
3287 @example
3288 extern long long extern_ll;
3289 extern_ll -->
3290 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3291 @end example
3292
3293 A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3294 'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3295 @code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
3296 requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3297 building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3298 merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3299 between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3300 constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3301
3302 Original:
3303 @example
3304 --foo.h
3305 extern int arr[];
3306 --foo.c
3307 #include "foo.h"
3308 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3309 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3310 @}
3311 @end example
3312
3313 Solution 1:
3314 @example
3315 --foo.h
3316 extern int arr[];
3317 --foo.c
3318 #include "foo.h"
3319 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3320 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3321 volatile int *parr = arr;
3322 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3323 @}
3324 @end example
3325
3326 Solution 2:
3327 @example
3328 --foo.h
3329 /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3330 #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3331 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3332 #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3333 #else
3334 #define FOO_IMPORT
3335 #endif
3336 extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3337 --foo.c
3338 #include "foo.h"
3339 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3340 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3341 @}
3342 @end example
3343
3344 A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3345 library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3346 for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3347 functions).
3348
3349 @kindex --disable-auto-import
3350 @item --disable-auto-import
3351 Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3352 @code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3353 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3354
3355 @kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3356 @item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3357 If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3358 that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3359 a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3360 environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3361 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3362
3363 @kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3364 @item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3365 Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3366 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3367
3368 @kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3369 @item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3370 Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3371 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3372
3373 @kindex --section-alignment
3374 @item --section-alignment
3375 Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3376 addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
3377 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3378
3379 @cindex stack size
3380 @kindex --stack
3381 @item --stack @var{reserve}
3382 @itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3383 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3384 to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3385 committed.
3386 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3387
3388 @kindex --subsystem
3389 @item --subsystem @var{which}
3390 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3391 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3392 Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3393 legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3394 @code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3395 the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3396 @var{which}.
3397 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3398
3399 The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3400 of the PE file header:
3401 [These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3402
3403 @kindex --high-entropy-va
3404 @item --high-entropy-va
3405 @itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3406 Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3407 (ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3408
3409 This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3410 @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3411
3412 @kindex --dynamicbase
3413 @item --dynamicbase
3414 @itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3415 The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3416 randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3417 Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3418 can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3419 This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3420
3421 @kindex --forceinteg
3422 @item --forceinteg
3423 @itemx --disable-forceinteg
3424 Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3425 default.
3426
3427 @kindex --nxcompat
3428 @item --nxcompat
3429 @item --disable-nxcompat
3430 The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3431 This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3432 targets. The option is enabled by default.
3433
3434 @kindex --no-isolation
3435 @item --no-isolation
3436 @itemx --disable-no-isolation
3437 Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3438 This option is disabled by default.
3439
3440 @kindex --no-seh
3441 @item --no-seh
3442 @itemx --disable-no-seh
3443 The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3444 this image. This option is disabled by default.
3445
3446 @kindex --no-bind
3447 @item --no-bind
3448 @itemx --disable-no-bind
3449 Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
3450
3451 @kindex --wdmdriver
3452 @item --wdmdriver
3453 @itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3454 The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3455 by default.
3456
3457 @kindex --tsaware
3458 @item --tsaware
3459 @itemx --disable-tsaware
3460 The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3461 default.
3462
3463 @kindex --insert-timestamp
3464 @item --insert-timestamp
3465 @itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3466 Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3467 as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3468 other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
3469 will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3470 same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3471 can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3472 that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3473 identically.
3474
3475 @kindex --enable-reloc-section
3476 @item --enable-reloc-section
3477 @itemx --disable-reloc-section
3478 Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3479 is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3480 This option is enabled by default.
3481 @end table
3482
3483 @c man end
3484
3485 @ifset C6X
3486 @subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3487
3488 @c man begin OPTIONS
3489
3490 The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3491 libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3492 all executables use an index of 0.
3493
3494 @table @gcctabopt
3495
3496 @kindex --dsbt-size
3497 @item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3498 This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3499 or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3500 entries.
3501
3502 @kindex --dsbt-index
3503 @item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3504 This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3505 to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3506 executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3507 @code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3508
3509 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3510 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3511 exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3512
3513 @end table
3514
3515 @c man end
3516 @end ifset
3517
3518 @ifset CSKY
3519 @subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3520
3521 @c man begin OPTIONS
3522
3523 @table @gcctabopt
3524
3525 @kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3526 @item --branch-stub
3527 This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3528 sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3529 usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3530 can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3531 the compiler or assembler.
3532
3533 @kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3534 @item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3535 This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3536 It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3537 be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3538 stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3539 sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3540 @samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3541 linker should choose suitable defaults.
3542
3543 @end table
3544
3545 @c man end
3546 @end ifset
3547
3548 @ifset M68HC11
3549 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3550
3551 @c man begin OPTIONS
3552
3553 The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3554 memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3555
3556 @table @gcctabopt
3557
3558 @kindex --no-trampoline
3559 @item --no-trampoline
3560 This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3561 is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3562 instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3563
3564 @kindex --bank-window
3565 @item --bank-window @var{name}
3566 This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3567 the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3568 The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3569 paging and addresses within the memory window.
3570
3571 @end table
3572
3573 @c man end
3574 @end ifset
3575
3576 @ifset M68K
3577 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3578
3579 @c man begin OPTIONS
3580
3581 The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3582 when linking for 68K targets.
3583
3584 @table @gcctabopt
3585
3586 @kindex --got
3587 @item --got=@var{type}
3588 This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3589 @var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3590 @samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3591 Info entry for @file{ld}.
3592
3593 @end table
3594
3595 @c man end
3596 @end ifset
3597
3598 @ifset MIPS
3599 @subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3600
3601 @c man begin OPTIONS
3602
3603 The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3604 generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3605 linking for MIPS targets.
3606
3607 @table @gcctabopt
3608
3609 @kindex --insn32
3610 @item --insn32
3611 @kindex --no-insn32
3612 @itemx --no-insn32
3613 These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3614 generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3615 or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
3616 32-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3617 used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3618 possible.
3619
3620 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3621 @item --ignore-branch-isa
3622 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3623 @itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3624 These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3625 transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3626 accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3627 is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3628 instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3629 equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3630 calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3631 a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3632 an error.
3633
3634 @kindex --compact-branches
3635 @item --compact-branches
3636 @kindex --no-compact-branches
3637 @itemx --no-compact-branches
3638 These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3639 in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3640
3641 @end table
3642
3643 @c man end
3644 @end ifset
3645
3646
3647 @ifset PDP11
3648 @subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3649
3650 @c man begin OPTIONS
3651
3652 For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3653 produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3654 for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3655 targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3656 defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3657 here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3658
3659 @table @gcctabopt
3660
3661 @kindex -N
3662 @item -N
3663 @kindex --omagic
3664 @itemx --omagic
3665
3666 Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3667 indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3668 shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3669 writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3670 the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3671 programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3672 from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3673
3674 @kindex -n
3675 @item -n
3676 @kindex --nmagic
3677 @itemx --nmagic
3678
3679 Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3680 indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3681 be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3682 file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3683 byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3684 a @emph{pure executable} format.
3685
3686 @kindex -z
3687 @item -z
3688 @kindex --imagic
3689 @itemx --imagic
3690
3691 Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3692 indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3693 data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3694 instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3695 larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3696 to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3697 shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3698 option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3699 and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3700 this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3701 executable} format.
3702
3703 @kindex --no-omagic
3704 @item --no-omagic
3705
3706 Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3707
3708 @end table
3709
3710 @c man end
3711 @end ifset
3712
3713 @ifset UsesEnvVars
3714 @node Environment
3715 @section Environment Variables
3716
3717 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3718
3719 You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3720 @ifclear SingleFormat
3721 @code{GNUTARGET},
3722 @end ifclear
3723 @code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3724
3725 @ifclear SingleFormat
3726 @kindex GNUTARGET
3727 @cindex default input format
3728 @code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3729 use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3730 of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
3731 @code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3732 of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3733 attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3734 this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3735 there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3736 object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3737 BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3738 in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3739 @end ifclear
3740
3741 @kindex LDEMULATION
3742 @cindex default emulation
3743 @cindex emulation, default
3744 @code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3745 @samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3746 behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3747 available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3748 the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3749 variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3750 linker was configured.
3751
3752 @kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3753 @cindex demangling, default
3754 Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3755 @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3756 default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3757 a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3758 may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3759 options.
3760
3761 @c man end
3762 @end ifset
3763
3764 @node Scripts
3765 @chapter Linker Scripts
3766
3767 @cindex scripts
3768 @cindex linker scripts
3769 @cindex command files
3770 Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3771 written in the linker command language.
3772
3773 The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3774 the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3775 the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3776 more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3777 direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3778 described below.
3779
3780 The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3781 yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3782 linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3783 to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
3784 such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3785
3786 You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3787 line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3788 default linker script.
3789
3790 You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3791 to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3792 Linker Scripts}.
3793
3794 @menu
3795 * Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3796 * Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3797 * Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3798 * Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3799 * Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3800 * SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3801 * MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3802 * PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3803 * VERSION:: VERSION Command
3804 * Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3805 * Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3806 @end menu
3807
3808 @node Basic Script Concepts
3809 @section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3810 @cindex linker script concepts
3811 We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3812 describe the linker script language.
3813
3814 The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3815 file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3816 @dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3817 The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3818 purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3819 among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3820 section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3821 in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3822
3823 Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3824 also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3825 contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3826 the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3827 A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3828 area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3829 loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3830 which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3831 of debugging information.
3832
3833 Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3834 first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3835 the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3836 @dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3837 section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3838 same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3839 is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3840 (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3841 based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3842 RAM address would be the VMA.
3843
3844 You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3845 program with the @samp{-h} option.
3846
3847 Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3848 @dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3849 has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3850 information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3851 will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3852 static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3853 referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3854
3855 You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3856 program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3857 option.
3858
3859 @node Script Format
3860 @section Linker Script Format
3861 @cindex linker script format
3862 Linker scripts are text files.
3863
3864 You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3865 either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3866 symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3867 generally ignored.
3868
3869 Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3870 If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3871 otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3872 double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3873 file name.
3874
3875 You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3876 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3877 to whitespace.
3878
3879 @node Simple Example
3880 @section Simple Linker Script Example
3881 @cindex linker script example
3882 @cindex example of linker script
3883 Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3884
3885 The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3886 @samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3887 memory layout of the output file.
3888
3889 The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3890 describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3891 code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3892 @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3893 Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3894 your input files.
3895
3896 For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
3897 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3898 linker script which will do that:
3899 @smallexample
3900 SECTIONS
3901 @{
3902 . = 0x10000;
3903 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3904 . = 0x8000000;
3905 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3906 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3907 @}
3908 @end smallexample
3909
3910 You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3911 followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3912 descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3913
3914 The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3915 sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3916 counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3917 other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3918 current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3919 incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3920 @samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3921
3922 The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3923 required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3924 after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3925 which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3926 wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3927 means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3928
3929 Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3930 @samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3931 @samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3932
3933 The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3934 the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3935 at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3936 output section, the value of the location counter will be
3937 @samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3938 effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
3939 immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
3940
3941 The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3942 alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3943 example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3944 sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3945 may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3946 sections.
3947
3948 That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3949
3950 @node Simple Commands
3951 @section Simple Linker Script Commands
3952 @cindex linker script simple commands
3953 In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3954
3955 @menu
3956 * Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3957 * File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3958 @ifclear SingleFormat
3959 * Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3960 @end ifclear
3961
3962 * REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
3963 * Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3964 @end menu
3965
3966 @node Entry Point
3967 @subsection Setting the Entry Point
3968 @kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3969 @cindex start of execution
3970 @cindex first instruction
3971 @cindex entry point
3972 The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3973 point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3974 entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3975 @smallexample
3976 ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3977 @end smallexample
3978
3979 There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3980 entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3981 stopping when one of them succeeds:
3982 @itemize @bullet
3983 @item
3984 the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
3985 @item
3986 the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
3987 @item
3988 the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
3989 targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3990 check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
3991 @item
3992 the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
3993 executable is being created - the code section is usually
3994 @samp{.text}, but can be something else;
3995 @item
3996 The address @code{0}.
3997 @end itemize
3998
3999 @node File Commands
4000 @subsection Commands Dealing with Files
4001 @cindex linker script file commands
4002 Several linker script commands deal with files.
4003
4004 @table @code
4005 @item INCLUDE @var{filename}
4006 @kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
4007 @cindex including a linker script
4008 Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
4009 be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
4010 with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
4011 10 levels deep.
4012
4013 You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
4014 @code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
4015
4016 @item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4017 @itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4018 @kindex INPUT(@var{files})
4019 @cindex input files in linker scripts
4020 @cindex input object files in linker scripts
4021 @cindex linker script input object files
4022 The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
4023 in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
4024
4025 For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4026 a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4027 then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4028
4029 In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4030 script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4031
4032 In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4033 with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4034 located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
4035 for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4036 @code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4037 filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4038 @samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4039
4040 If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4041 the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
4042 found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
4043 not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4044 path.
4045
4046 If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
4047 name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
4048 @samp{-l}.
4049
4050 When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4051 files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4052 script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
4053
4054 @item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4055 @itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4056 @kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4057 @cindex grouping input files
4058 The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4059 files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4060 new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
4061 in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4062
4063 @item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4064 @itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4065 @kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4066 This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4067 commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4068 as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4069 with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4070 when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4071 @option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4072 and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4073 setting afterwards.
4074
4075 @item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4076 @kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4077 @cindex output file name in linker script
4078 The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4079 @code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4080 @samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
4081 Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
4082 precedence.
4083
4084 You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4085 output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4086
4087 @item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4088 @kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4089 @cindex library search path in linker script
4090 @cindex archive search path in linker script
4091 @cindex search path in linker script
4092 The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
4093 @command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
4094 @code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
4095 on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
4096 are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
4097 the command-line option are searched first.
4098
4099 @item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4100 @kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4101 @cindex first input file
4102 The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4103 that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4104 though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4105 when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4106 first file.
4107 @end table
4108
4109 @ifclear SingleFormat
4110 @node Format Commands
4111 @subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
4112 A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4113
4114 @table @code
4115 @item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4116 @itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4117 @kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4118 @cindex output file format in linker script
4119 The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4120 output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
4121 exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4122 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
4123 line option takes precedence.
4124
4125 You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
4126 formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
4127 This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4128 desired endianness.
4129
4130 If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4131 will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4132 output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4133 used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4134
4135 For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4136 command:
4137 @smallexample
4138 OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4139 @end smallexample
4140 This says that the default format for the output file is
4141 @samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
4142 option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4143 format.
4144
4145 @item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4146 @kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4147 @cindex input file format in linker script
4148 The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4149 files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4150 This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4151 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
4152 is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4153 command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4154 @end table
4155 @end ifclear
4156
4157 @node REGION_ALIAS
4158 @subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4159 @kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4160 @cindex region alias
4161 @cindex region names
4162
4163 Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4164 @ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4165
4166 @smallexample
4167 REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4168 @end smallexample
4169
4170 The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4171 memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4172 to memory regions. An example follows.
4173
4174 Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4175 memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4176 that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4177 non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4178 access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4179 read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4180 sections:
4181
4182 @itemize @bullet
4183 @item
4184 @code{.text} program code;
4185 @item
4186 @code{.rodata} read-only data;
4187 @item
4188 @code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4189 @item
4190 @code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4191 @end itemize
4192
4193 The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4194 part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4195 output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4196 systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4197 @code{C}:
4198 @multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4199 @item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
4200 @item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4201 @item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4202 @item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4203 @item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4204 @end multitable
4205 The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4206 loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4207 the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4208 the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4209
4210 The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4211 includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4212 memory layout:
4213 @smallexample
4214 INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4215
4216 SECTIONS
4217 @{
4218 .text :
4219 @{
4220 *(.text)
4221 @} > REGION_TEXT
4222 .rodata :
4223 @{
4224 *(.rodata)
4225 rodata_end = .;
4226 @} > REGION_RODATA
4227 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4228 @{
4229 data_start = .;
4230 *(.data)
4231 @} > REGION_DATA
4232 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4233 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4234 .bss :
4235 @{
4236 *(.bss)
4237 @} > REGION_BSS
4238 @}
4239 @end smallexample
4240
4241 Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4242 regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4243 variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4244 @table @code
4245 @item A
4246 Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4247 @smallexample
4248 MEMORY
4249 @{
4250 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4251 @}
4252
4253 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4254 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4255 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4256 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4257 @end smallexample
4258 @item B
4259 Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4260 into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4261 @code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4262 @smallexample
4263 MEMORY
4264 @{
4265 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4266 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4267 @}
4268
4269 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4270 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4271 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4272 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4273 @end smallexample
4274 @item C
4275 Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4276 @code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4277 initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4278 system start into the @code{RAM}.
4279 @smallexample
4280 MEMORY
4281 @{
4282 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4283 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4284 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4285 @}
4286
4287 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4288 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4289 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4290 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4291 @end smallexample
4292 @end table
4293
4294 It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4295 @code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4296 necessary:
4297 @smallexample
4298 #include <string.h>
4299
4300 extern char data_start [];
4301 extern char data_size [];
4302 extern char data_load_start [];
4303
4304 void copy_data(void)
4305 @{
4306 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4307 @{
4308 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4309 @}
4310 @}
4311 @end smallexample
4312
4313 @node Miscellaneous Commands
4314 @subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4315 There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4316
4317 @table @code
4318 @item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4319 @kindex ASSERT
4320 @cindex assertion in linker script
4321 Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4322 with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4323
4324 Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4325 take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4326 inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4327 for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4328 symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4329
4330 @smallexample
4331 .stack :
4332 @{
4333 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4334 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4335 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4336 @}
4337 @end smallexample
4338
4339 will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4340 PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4341 can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4342
4343 @smallexample
4344 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4345 .stack :
4346 @{
4347 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4348 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4349 @}
4350 @end smallexample
4351
4352 will work.
4353
4354 @item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4355 @kindex EXTERN
4356 @cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4357 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4358 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4359 modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4360 each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4361 command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4362
4363 @item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4364 @kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4365 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4366 This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4367 to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4368 output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4369
4370 @item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4371 @kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4372 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4373 This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4374 command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4375 to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4376
4377 @item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4378 @kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4379 @cindex group allocation in linker script
4380 @cindex section groups
4381 @cindex COMDAT
4382 This command has the same effect as the
4383 @samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4384 @command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4385 and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4386 specified (@samp{-r}).
4387
4388 @item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4389 @kindex INSERT
4390 @cindex insert user script into default script
4391 This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4392 augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4393 inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4394 @var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4395 default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4396 sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4397 linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4398 insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4399 linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4400 default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4401 of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4402 to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4403 is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4404
4405 @smallexample
4406 SECTIONS
4407 @{
4408 OVERLAY :
4409 @{
4410 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4411 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4412 @}
4413 @}
4414 INSERT AFTER .text;
4415 @end smallexample
4416
4417 @item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4418 @kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4419 @cindex cross references
4420 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4421 references among certain output sections.
4422
4423 In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4424 using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4425 will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4426 errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4427 a function defined in the other section.
4428
4429 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
4430 @command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4431 an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4432 @code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4433 names.
4434
4435 @item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4436 @kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4437 @cindex cross references
4438 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4439 references to one section from a list of other sections.
4440
4441 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4442 output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4443 a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4444 there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4445 must never call back.
4446
4447 The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4448 The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4449 If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4450 the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4451 status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4452 names, not input section names.
4453
4454 @ifclear SingleFormat
4455 @item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4456 @kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4457 @cindex machine architecture
4458 @cindex architecture
4459 Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4460 of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4461 architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4462 the @samp{-f} option.
4463 @end ifclear
4464
4465 @item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4466 @kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4467 This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4468 @var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4469 in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4470 @xref{Expression Section}.
4471 @end table
4472
4473 @node Assignments
4474 @section Assigning Values to Symbols
4475 @cindex assignment in scripts
4476 @cindex symbol definition, scripts
4477 @cindex variables, defining
4478 You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
4479 the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4480
4481 @menu
4482 * Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
4483 * HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
4484 * PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
4485 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4486 * Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4487 @end menu
4488
4489 @node Simple Assignments
4490 @subsection Simple Assignments
4491
4492 You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4493
4494 @table @code
4495 @item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4496 @itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4497 @itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4498 @itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4499 @itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4500 @itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4501 @itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4502 @itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4503 @itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4504 @end table
4505
4506 The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4507 @var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4508 defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4509
4510 The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
4511 may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
4512
4513 The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4514
4515 Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4516
4517 You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4518 statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4519 section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4520
4521 The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4522 expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4523
4524 Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4525 assignments may be used:
4526
4527 @smallexample
4528 floating_point = 0;
4529 SECTIONS
4530 @{
4531 .text :
4532 @{
4533 *(.text)
4534 _etext = .;
4535 @}
4536 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4537 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4538 @}
4539 @end smallexample
4540 @noindent
4541 In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4542 zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4543 the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4544 defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4545 upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4546
4547 @node HIDDEN
4548 @subsection HIDDEN
4549 @cindex HIDDEN
4550 For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4551 exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4552
4553 Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4554 @code{HIDDEN}:
4555
4556 @smallexample
4557 HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4558 SECTIONS
4559 @{
4560 .text :
4561 @{
4562 *(.text)
4563 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4564 @}
4565 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4566 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4567 @}
4568 @end smallexample
4569 @noindent
4570 In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4571
4572 @node PROVIDE
4573 @subsection PROVIDE
4574 @cindex PROVIDE
4575 In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4576 only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4577 the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4578 @samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4579 @samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4580 @code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4581 @samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4582 @code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4583
4584 Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4585 @smallexample
4586 SECTIONS
4587 @{
4588 .text :
4589 @{
4590 *(.text)
4591 _etext = .;
4592 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4593 @}
4594 @}
4595 @end smallexample
4596
4597 In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4598 underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4599 on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4600 underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4601 If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4602 linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4603
4604 Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4605 defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4606 that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4607 when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4608 @samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4609
4610 @node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4611 @subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4612 @cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4613 Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4614 hidden and won't be exported.
4615
4616 @node Source Code Reference
4617 @subsection Source Code Reference
4618
4619 Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4620 intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4621 a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4622 symbol that does not have a value.
4623
4624 Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4625 transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4626 stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4627 prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4628 mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4629 of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4630 variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4631 linker script variable might be referred to as:
4632
4633 @smallexample
4634 extern int foo;
4635 @end smallexample
4636
4637 But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4638
4639 @smallexample
4640 _foo = 1000;
4641 @end smallexample
4642
4643 In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4644 transformation has taken place.
4645
4646 When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4647 things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4648 in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4649 second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4650 table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4651 contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4652 value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4653
4654 @smallexample
4655 int foo = 1000;
4656 @end smallexample
4657
4658 creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
4659 holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4660 number 1000 is initially stored.
4661
4662 When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4663 first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4664 memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4665 So:
4666
4667 @smallexample
4668 foo = 1;
4669 @end smallexample
4670
4671 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4672 associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4673 address. Whereas:
4674
4675 @smallexample
4676 int * a = & foo;
4677 @end smallexample
4678
4679 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4680 and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4681 the variable @samp{a}.
4682
4683 Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4684 the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4685 an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 foo = 1000;
4689 @end smallexample
4690
4691 creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4692 the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4693 address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4694 linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4695 access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4696
4697 Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4698 you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4699 use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4700 section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4701 linker script contains these declarations:
4702
4703 @smallexample
4704 @group
4705 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
4706 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4707 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4708 @end group
4709 @end smallexample
4710
4711 Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4712
4713 @smallexample
4714 @group
4715 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4716
4717 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4718 @end group
4719 @end smallexample
4720
4721 Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
4722 Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4723 arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4724
4725 @smallexample
4726 @group
4727 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4728
4729 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4730 @end group
4731 @end smallexample
4732
4733 Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4734 operators.
4735
4736 @node SECTIONS
4737 @section SECTIONS Command
4738 @kindex SECTIONS
4739 The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4740 into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4741
4742 The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4743 @smallexample
4744 SECTIONS
4745 @{
4746 @var{sections-command}
4747 @var{sections-command}
4748 @dots{}
4749 @}
4750 @end smallexample
4751
4752 Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4753
4754 @itemize @bullet
4755 @item
4756 an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4757 @item
4758 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4759 @item
4760 an output section description
4761 @item
4762 an overlay description
4763 @end itemize
4764
4765 The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4766 @code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4767 those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4768 understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4769 the layout of the output file.
4770
4771 Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4772 below.
4773
4774 If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4775 linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4776 section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4777 input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4778 example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4779 in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4780
4781 @menu
4782 * Output Section Description:: Output section description
4783 * Output Section Name:: Output section name
4784 * Output Section Address:: Output section address
4785 * Input Section:: Input section description
4786 * Output Section Data:: Output section data
4787 * Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4788 * Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4789 * Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4790 * Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4791 @end menu
4792
4793 @node Output Section Description
4794 @subsection Output Section Description
4795 The full description of an output section looks like this:
4796 @smallexample
4797 @group
4798 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4799 [AT(@var{lma})]
4800 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4801 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4802 [@var{constraint}]
4803 @{
4804 @var{output-section-command}
4805 @var{output-section-command}
4806 @dots{}
4807 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4808 @end group
4809 @end smallexample
4810
4811 Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4812
4813 The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4814 name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4815 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4816 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4817 The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4818
4819 Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4820
4821 @itemize @bullet
4822 @item
4823 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4824 @item
4825 an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4826 @item
4827 data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4828 @item
4829 a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4830 @end itemize
4831
4832 @node Output Section Name
4833 @subsection Output Section Name
4834 @cindex name, section
4835 @cindex section name
4836 The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4837 meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4838 support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4839 must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4840 example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4841 output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4842 names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4843 quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4844 characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4845 commas must be quoted.
4846
4847 The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4848 Discarding}.
4849
4850 @node Output Section Address
4851 @subsection Output Section Address
4852 @cindex address, section
4853 @cindex section address
4854 The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
4855 address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4856 is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4857
4858 If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4859 section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4860 to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4861 alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4862 contained within the output section.
4863
4864 The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4865
4866 @itemize @bullet
4867 @item
4868 If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4869 is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4870 in that region.
4871
4872 @item
4873 If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4874 regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4875 section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4876 be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4877
4878 @item
4879 If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4880 the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4881 counter.
4882 @end itemize
4883
4884 @noindent
4885 For example:
4886
4887 @smallexample
4888 .text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4889 @end smallexample
4890
4891 @noindent
4892 and
4893
4894 @smallexample
4895 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4896 @end smallexample
4897
4898 @noindent
4899 are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4900 @samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4901 counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
4902 counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4903 input sections.
4904
4905 The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4906 For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4907 so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4908 do something like this:
4909 @smallexample
4910 .text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4911 @end smallexample
4912 @noindent
4913 This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4914 aligned upward to the specified value.
4915
4916 Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
4917 location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4918 sections are ignored).
4919
4920 @node Input Section
4921 @subsection Input Section Description
4922 @cindex input sections
4923 @cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4924 The most common output section command is an input section description.
4925
4926 The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4927 You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4928 in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4929 map the input files into your memory layout.
4930
4931 @menu
4932 * Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4933 * Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4934 * Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4935 * Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4936 * Input Section Example:: Input section example
4937 @end menu
4938
4939 @node Input Section Basics
4940 @subsubsection Input Section Basics
4941 @cindex input section basics
4942 An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4943 by a list of section names in parentheses.
4944
4945 The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4946 describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4947
4948 The most common input section description is to include all input
4949 sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4950 include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4951 @smallexample
4952 *(.text)
4953 @end smallexample
4954 @noindent
4955 Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
4956 @cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
4957 of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4958 match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4959 example:
4960 @smallexample
4961 EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4962 @end smallexample
4963 @noindent
4964 will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4965 and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4966 placed inside the section list, for example:
4967 @smallexample
4968 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
4969 @end smallexample
4970 @noindent
4971 The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4972 two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4973 more than one section, as described below.
4974
4975 There are two ways to include more than one section:
4976 @smallexample
4977 *(.text .rdata)
4978 *(.text) *(.rdata)
4979 @end smallexample
4980 @noindent
4981 The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4982 @samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
4983 first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4984 they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
4985 @samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4986 @samp{.rdata} input sections.
4987
4988 When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4989 is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4990 immediately following section, for example:
4991 @smallexample
4992 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4993 @end smallexample
4994 @noindent
4995 will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4996 @file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4997 from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4998 exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
4999 could be modified to:
5000 @smallexample
5001 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
5002 @end smallexample
5003 @noindent
5004 Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
5005 before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
5006 all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
5007 @smallexample
5008 EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
5009 @end smallexample
5010
5011 You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
5012 You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
5013 needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
5014 @smallexample
5015 data.o(.data)
5016 @end smallexample
5017
5018 To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
5019 of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
5020
5021 Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
5022
5023 @smallexample
5024 @group
5025 SECTIONS @{
5026 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5027 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5028 @}
5029 @end group
5030 @end smallexample
5031
5032 In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5033 input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5034 @code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
5035 @samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5036 whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5037
5038 You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5039 matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5040 with no whitespace around the colon.
5041
5042 @table @samp
5043 @item archive:file
5044 matches file within archive
5045 @item archive:
5046 matches the whole archive
5047 @item :file
5048 matches file but not one in an archive
5049 @end table
5050
5051 Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5052 wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5053 single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5054 @samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5055 within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5056 also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5057 other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
5058 from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5059 command.
5060
5061 If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5062 the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
5063 commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
5064 @smallexample
5065 data.o
5066 @end smallexample
5067
5068 When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5069 and does not contain any wild card
5070 characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5071 name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5072 did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5073 though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5074 @code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5075 the archive search path.
5076
5077 @node Input Section Wildcards
5078 @subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
5079 @cindex input section wildcards
5080 @cindex wildcard file name patterns
5081 @cindex file name wildcard patterns
5082 @cindex section name wildcard patterns
5083 In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5084 name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5085
5086 The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5087 pattern for the file name.
5088
5089 The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5090
5091 @table @samp
5092 @item *
5093 matches any number of characters
5094 @item ?
5095 matches any single character
5096 @item [@var{chars}]
5097 matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5098 character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5099 @samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5100 @item \
5101 quotes the following character
5102 @end table
5103
5104 File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5105 specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5106 does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5107
5108 If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5109 appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5110 will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5111 sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5112 @file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5113 @smallexample
5114 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5115 .data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5116 @end smallexample
5117
5118 @cindex SORT_BY_NAME
5119 Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5120 in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
5121 this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5122 pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5123 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
5124 into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5125
5126 @cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
5127 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5128 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5129 alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5130 alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5131 needed.
5132
5133 @cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
5134 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5135 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5136 numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5137 section name before placing them in the output file. In
5138 @code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5139 the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5140 @code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
5141
5142 @cindex SORT
5143 @code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5144
5145 When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5146 can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5147
5148 @enumerate
5149 @item
5150 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5151 It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
5152 sections have the same name.
5153 @item
5154 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5155 It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
5156 sections have the same alignment.
5157 @item
5158 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
5159 treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5160 @item
5161 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5162 is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5163 @item
5164 All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5165 @end enumerate
5166
5167 When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
5168 section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
5169 takes precedence over the command-line option.
5170
5171 If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
5172 command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
5173 treated as nested sorting command.
5174
5175 @enumerate
5176 @item
5177 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5178 @option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5179 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5180 @item
5181 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5182 @option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5183 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5184 @end enumerate
5185
5186 If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
5187 command-line option will be ignored.
5188
5189 @cindex SORT_NONE
5190 @code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
5191 section sorting option.
5192
5193 If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5194 @samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5195 precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5196
5197 This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5198 files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5199 sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5200 The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5201 with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5202 linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5203 @smallexample
5204 @group
5205 SECTIONS @{
5206 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5207 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5208 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5209 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5210 @}
5211 @end group
5212 @end smallexample
5213
5214 @node Input Section Common
5215 @subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
5216 @cindex common symbol placement
5217 @cindex uninitialized data placement
5218 A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5219 file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5220 linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5221 named @samp{COMMON}.
5222
5223 You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5224 other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5225 particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5226 input files are placed in another section.
5227
5228 In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5229 @samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5230 @smallexample
5231 .bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5232 @end smallexample
5233
5234 @cindex scommon section
5235 @cindex small common symbols
5236 Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5237 example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5238 symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5239 different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5240 the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5241 symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5242 to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5243 locations.
5244
5245 @cindex [COMMON]
5246 You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5247 notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5248 @samp{*(COMMON)}.
5249
5250 @node Input Section Keep
5251 @subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
5252 @cindex KEEP
5253 @cindex garbage collection
5254 When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
5255 it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
5256 This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5257 with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
5258 @code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
5259
5260 @node Input Section Example
5261 @subsubsection Input Section Example
5262 The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5263 to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5264 start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5265 @samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5266 follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5267 @samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5268 @samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5269 All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5270 files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5271
5272 @smallexample
5273 @group
5274 SECTIONS @{
5275 outputa 0x10000 :
5276 @{
5277 all.o
5278 foo.o (.input1)
5279 @}
5280 @end group
5281 @group
5282 outputb :
5283 @{
5284 foo.o (.input2)
5285 foo1.o (.input1)
5286 @}
5287 @end group
5288 @group
5289 outputc :
5290 @{
5291 *(.input1)
5292 *(.input2)
5293 @}
5294 @}
5295 @end group
5296 @end smallexample
5297
5298 If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5299 and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5300 automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5301 __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5302 indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5303 respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5304 C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5305
5306 @node Output Section Data
5307 @subsection Output Section Data
5308 @cindex data
5309 @cindex section data
5310 @cindex output section data
5311 @kindex ASCIZ ``@var{string}''
5312 @kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5313 @kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5314 @kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5315 @kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5316 @kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5317 You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5318 @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5319 an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5320 parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5321 value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5322 counter.
5323
5324 The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5325 store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5326 bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5327 stored.
5328
5329 For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5330 of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5331 @smallexample
5332 BYTE(1)
5333 LONG(addr)
5334 @end smallexample
5335
5336 When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5337 same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5338 target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5339 @code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5340 @code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5341
5342 If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5343 which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5344 When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5345 true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5346 endianness of the first input object file.
5347
5348 You can include a zero-terminated string in an output section by using
5349 @code{ASCIZ}. The keyword is followed by a string which is stored at
5350 the current value of the location counter adding a zero byte at the
5351 end. If the string includes spaces it must be enclosed in double
5352 quotes. The string may contain '\n', '\r', '\t' and octal numbers.
5353 Hex numbers are not supported.
5354
5355 For example, this string of 16 characters will create a 17 byte area
5356 @smallexample
5357 ASCIZ "This is 16 bytes"
5358 @end smallexample
5359
5360 Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5361 between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5362 @smallexample
5363 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5364 @end smallexample
5365 whereas this will work:
5366 @smallexample
5367 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5368 @end smallexample
5369
5370 @kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5371 @cindex holes, filling
5372 @cindex unspecified memory
5373 You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5374 current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5375 otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5376 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5377 with the value of the expression, repeated as
5378 necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5379 point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5380 than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5381 different parts of an output section.
5382
5383 This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5384 value @samp{0x90}:
5385 @smallexample
5386 FILL(0x90909090)
5387 @end smallexample
5388
5389 The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5390 section attribute, but it only affects the
5391 part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5392 entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5393 precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5394 expression.
5395
5396 @node Output Section Keywords
5397 @subsection Output Section Keywords
5398 There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5399 commands.
5400
5401 @table @code
5402 @kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5403 @cindex input filename symbols
5404 @cindex filename symbols
5405 @item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5406 The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5407 The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5408 file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5409 the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5410
5411 This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5412 normally used for any other object file format.
5413
5414 @kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5415 @cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5416 @cindex constructors, arranging in link
5417 @item CONSTRUCTORS
5418 When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5419 unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5420 destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5421 arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5422 automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5423 For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5424 linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5425 @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5426 ignored for other object file formats.
5427
5428 The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5429 constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5430 Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5431 the start and end of the global destructors. The
5432 first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5433 of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5434 compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5435 formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5436 @code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5437 the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5438 destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5439 @code{exit}.
5440
5441 For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5442 arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5443 addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5444 and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5445 linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5446 runtime code expects to see.
5447
5448 @smallexample
5449 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5450 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5451 *(.ctors)
5452 LONG(0)
5453 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5454 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5455 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5456 *(.dtors)
5457 LONG(0)
5458 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5459 @end smallexample
5460
5461 If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5462 which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5463 are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5464 are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5465 command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5466 @code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5467 @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5468 @samp{*(.dtors)}.
5469
5470 Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5471 and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5472 need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5473 scripts.
5474
5475 @end table
5476
5477 @node Output Section Discarding
5478 @subsection Output Section Discarding
5479 @cindex discarding sections
5480 @cindex sections, discarding
5481 @cindex removing sections
5482 The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5483 This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5484 may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
5485 @smallexample
5486 .foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5487 @end smallexample
5488 @noindent
5489 will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5490 @samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5491 sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
5492 space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5493 too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5494 space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5495 @samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5496 @samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5497 This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5498
5499 The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5500 on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5501 symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
5502 the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5503 section is discarded.
5504
5505 @cindex /DISCARD/
5506 The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5507 input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5508 section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5509
5510 This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5511 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5512 garbage collection.
5513
5514 Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5515 discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5516 members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5517 Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5518
5519 @node Output Section Attributes
5520 @subsection Output Section Attributes
5521 @cindex output section attributes
5522 We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5523 like this:
5524
5525 @smallexample
5526 @group
5527 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5528 [AT(@var{lma})]
5529 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5530 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5531 [@var{constraint}]
5532 @{
5533 @var{output-section-command}
5534 @var{output-section-command}
5535 @dots{}
5536 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5537 @end group
5538 @end smallexample
5539
5540 We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5541 @var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5542 remaining section attributes.
5543
5544 @menu
5545 * Output Section Type:: Output section type
5546 * Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
5547 * Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
5548 * Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
5549 * Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
5550 * Output Section Region:: Output section region
5551 * Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5552 * Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5553 @end menu
5554
5555 @node Output Section Type
5556 @subsubsection Output Section Type
5557 Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5558 parentheses. The following types are defined:
5559
5560 @table @code
5561
5562 @item NOLOAD
5563 The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5564 loaded into memory when the program is run.
5565
5566 @item READONLY
5567 The section should be marked as read-only.
5568
5569 @item DSECT
5570 @item COPY
5571 @item INFO
5572 @item OVERLAY
5573 These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5574 rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5575 marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5576 section when the program is run.
5577
5578 @item TYPE = @var{type}
5579 Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5580 output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5581 @code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
5582 @code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5583 for @var{type}. It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5584 special requirements of the section type are met.
5585
5586 Note - the TYPE only is used if some or all of the contents of the
5587 section do not have an implicit type of their own. So for example:
5588 @smallexample
5589 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ *(.bar) @}
5590 @end smallexample
5591 will set the type of section @samp{.foo} to the type of the section
5592 @samp{.bar} in the input files, which may not be the SHT_PROGBITS
5593 type. Whereas:
5594 @smallexample
5595 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1) @}
5596 @end smallexample
5597 will set the type of @samp{.foo} to SHT_PROGBBITS. If it is necessary
5598 to override the type of incoming sections and force the output section
5599 type then an extra piece of untyped data will be needed:
5600 @smallexample
5601 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1); *(.bar) @}
5602 @end smallexample
5603
5604 @item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5605 This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5606 type specified by @var{type}.
5607
5608 @end table
5609
5610 @kindex NOLOAD
5611 @cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5612 @cindex loading, preventing
5613 The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5614 the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5615 the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5616 @samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5617 need to be loaded when the program is run.
5618 @smallexample
5619 @group
5620 SECTIONS @{
5621 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5622 @dots{}
5623 @}
5624 @end group
5625 @end smallexample
5626
5627 @node Output Section LMA
5628 @subsubsection Output Section LMA
5629 @kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5630 @kindex AT(@var{lma})
5631 @cindex load address
5632 @cindex section load address
5633 Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5634 @ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5635 @pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5636 specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5637 address is optional.
5638
5639 The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5640 specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5641 takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5642 load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5643 region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5644
5645 If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5646 section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5647 load address:
5648
5649 @itemize @bullet
5650 @item
5651 If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5652 the LMA address as well.
5653
5654 @item
5655 If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5656
5657 @item
5658 Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5659 with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5660 section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5661 VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5662 the last section in the located region.
5663
5664 @item
5665 If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5666 that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5667
5668 @item
5669 If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5670 section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5671 @end itemize
5672
5673 @cindex ROM initialized data
5674 @cindex initialized data in ROM
5675 This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5676 example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5677 called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5678 @samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5679 even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5680 uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5681 defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5682 counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5683
5684 @smallexample
5685 @group
5686 SECTIONS
5687 @{
5688 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5689 .mdata 0x2000 :
5690 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5691 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5692 .bss 0x3000 :
5693 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5694 @}
5695 @end group
5696 @end smallexample
5697
5698 The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5699 this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5700 the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5701 how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5702 script.
5703
5704 @smallexample
5705 @group
5706 extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5707 char *src = &_etext;
5708 char *dst = &_data;
5709
5710 /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5711 while (dst < &_edata)
5712 *dst++ = *src++;
5713
5714 /* Zero bss. */
5715 for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5716 *dst = 0;
5717 @end group
5718 @end smallexample
5719
5720 @node Forced Output Alignment
5721 @subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5722 @kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5723 @cindex forcing output section alignment
5724 @cindex output section alignment
5725 You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
5726 alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5727 intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5728
5729 @node Forced Input Alignment
5730 @subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5731 @kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5732 @cindex forcing input section alignment
5733 @cindex input section alignment
5734 You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5735 SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5736 sections, whether larger or smaller.
5737
5738 @node Output Section Constraint
5739 @subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5740 @kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5741 @kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5742 @cindex constraints on output sections
5743 You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5744 of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5745 read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5746 @code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5747
5748 @node Output Section Region
5749 @subsubsection Output Section Region
5750 @kindex >@var{region}
5751 @cindex section, assigning to memory region
5752 @cindex memory regions and sections
5753 You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5754 using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5755
5756 Here is a simple example:
5757 @smallexample
5758 @group
5759 MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5760 SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5761 @end group
5762 @end smallexample
5763
5764 @node Output Section Phdr
5765 @subsubsection Output Section Phdr
5766 @kindex :@var{phdr}
5767 @cindex section, assigning to program header
5768 @cindex program headers and sections
5769 You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5770 using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5771 one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5772 assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5773 @code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5774 linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5775
5776 Here is a simple example:
5777 @smallexample
5778 @group
5779 PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5780 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5781 @end group
5782 @end smallexample
5783
5784 @node Output Section Fill
5785 @subsubsection Output Section Fill
5786 @kindex =@var{fillexp}
5787 @cindex section fill pattern
5788 @cindex fill pattern, entire section
5789 You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5790 @samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5791 (@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5792 within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
5793 alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5794 necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
5795 of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
5796 an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5797 fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
5798 other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
5799 pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5800 expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
5801
5802 You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
5803 output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
5804
5805 Here is a simple example:
5806 @smallexample
5807 @group
5808 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
5809 @end group
5810 @end smallexample
5811
5812 @node Overlay Description
5813 @subsection Overlay Description
5814 @kindex OVERLAY
5815 @cindex overlays
5816 An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5817 are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5818 the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5819 copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5820 required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5821 can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5822 than another.
5823
5824 Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5825 @code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5826 output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5827 command is as follows:
5828 @smallexample
5829 @group
5830 OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5831 @{
5832 @var{secname1}
5833 @{
5834 @var{output-section-command}
5835 @var{output-section-command}
5836 @dots{}
5837 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5838 @var{secname2}
5839 @{
5840 @var{output-section-command}
5841 @var{output-section-command}
5842 @dots{}
5843 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5844 @dots{}
5845 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
5846 @end group
5847 @end smallexample
5848
5849 Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5850 section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5851 section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
5852 those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
5853 except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5854 sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5855
5856 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5857 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5858
5859 The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5860 addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5861 memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5862 whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5863 and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5864 and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5865
5866 If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5867 references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5868 the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5869 sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5870 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
5871
5872 For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
5873 provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
5874 defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5875 @code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5876 the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5877 within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5878 symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5879
5880 At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5881 the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5882
5883 Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5884 @code{SECTIONS} construct.
5885 @smallexample
5886 @group
5887 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5888 @{
5889 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5890 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5891 @}
5892 @end group
5893 @end smallexample
5894 @noindent
5895 This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5896 address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5897 @samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
5898 following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
5899 @code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5900 @code{__load_stop_text1}.
5901
5902 C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5903 like the following.
5904
5905 @smallexample
5906 @group
5907 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5908 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5909 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5910 @end group
5911 @end smallexample
5912
5913 Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5914 everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5915 example could have been written identically as follows.
5916
5917 @smallexample
5918 @group
5919 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5920 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5921 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
5922 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5923 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5924 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
5925 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5926 @end group
5927 @end smallexample
5928
5929 @node MEMORY
5930 @section MEMORY Command
5931 @kindex MEMORY
5932 @cindex memory regions
5933 @cindex regions of memory
5934 @cindex allocating memory
5935 @cindex discontinuous memory
5936 The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5937 memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5938
5939 The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5940 memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5941 may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5942 can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5943 set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5944 regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5945 around to fit into the available regions.
5946
5947 A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5948 however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5949 specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5950 @code{MEMORY} is:
5951 @smallexample
5952 @group
5953 MEMORY
5954 @{
5955 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5956 @dots{}
5957 @}
5958 @end group
5959 @end smallexample
5960
5961 The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5962 region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5963 Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5964 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
5965 must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5966 add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
5967 command.
5968
5969 @cindex memory region attributes
5970 The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5971 whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5972 not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5973 @ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5974 section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5975 the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5976 them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5977
5978 The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5979 @table @samp
5980 @item R
5981 Read-only section
5982 @item W
5983 Read/write section
5984 @item X
5985 Executable section
5986 @item A
5987 Allocatable section
5988 @item I
5989 Initialized section
5990 @item L
5991 Same as @samp{I}
5992 @item !
5993 Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
5994 @end table
5995
5996 If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
5997 @samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
5998 attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5999 unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
6000 not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
6001 string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
6002 or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
6003 the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
6004
6005 @kindex ORIGIN =
6006 @kindex o =
6007 @kindex org =
6008 The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
6009 the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
6010 cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
6011 abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
6012 @code{ORG}).
6013
6014 @kindex LENGTH =
6015 @kindex len =
6016 @kindex l =
6017 The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
6018 region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
6019 be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
6020 @code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
6021
6022 In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
6023 available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
6024 and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
6025 linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
6026 is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
6027 or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
6028 explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
6029 region.
6030
6031 @smallexample
6032 @group
6033 MEMORY
6034 @{
6035 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
6036 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
6037 @}
6038 @end group
6039 @end smallexample
6040
6041 Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
6042 specific output sections into that memory region by using the
6043 @samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
6044 a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
6045 output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
6046 was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
6047 the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
6048 output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
6049 region, the linker will issue an error message.
6050
6051 It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
6052 expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
6053 @code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
6054
6055 @smallexample
6056 @group
6057 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
6058 @end group
6059 @end smallexample
6060
6061 @node PHDRS
6062 @section PHDRS Command
6063 @kindex PHDRS
6064 @cindex program headers
6065 @cindex ELF program headers
6066 @cindex program segments
6067 @cindex segments, ELF
6068 The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6069 @dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
6070 loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6071 program with the @samp{-p} option.
6072
6073 When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6074 reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6075 program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6076 This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6077 interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6078
6079 The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
6080 in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6081 precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
6082 the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6083 not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6084
6085 The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6086 generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
6087 ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6088
6089 This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
6090 @code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6091
6092 @smallexample
6093 @group
6094 PHDRS
6095 @{
6096 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6097 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6098 @}
6099 @end group
6100 @end smallexample
6101
6102 The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6103 of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
6104 header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6105 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
6106 must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
6107 is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
6108
6109 Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6110 system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
6111 specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6112 sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6113 attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
6114 Section Phdr}.
6115
6116 It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6117 merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6118 repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6119 contain the section.
6120
6121 If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6122 then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6123 not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6124 convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6125 placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6126 default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6127 segment at all.
6128
6129 @kindex FILEHDR
6130 @kindex PHDRS
6131 You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
6132 the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6133 The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6134 file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
6135 include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
6136 segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6137 these keywords.
6138
6139 The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6140 value of the keyword.
6141
6142 @table @asis
6143 @item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6144 Indicates an unused program header.
6145
6146 @item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6147 Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6148 the file.
6149
6150 @item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6151 Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6152
6153 @item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6154 Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6155 found.
6156
6157 @item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6158 Indicates a segment holding note information.
6159
6160 @item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6161 A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6162 ABI.
6163
6164 @item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6165 Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6166
6167 @item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6168 Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6169
6170 @item @var{expression}
6171 An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6172 be used for types not defined above.
6173 @end table
6174
6175 You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6176 in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6177 @code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6178 Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6179 output section attribute.
6180
6181 The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6182 which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6183 explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6184 an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6185 header.
6186
6187 Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6188 headers used on a native ELF system.
6189
6190 @example
6191 @group
6192 PHDRS
6193 @{
6194 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6195 interp PT_INTERP ;
6196 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6197 data PT_LOAD ;
6198 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6199 @}
6200
6201 SECTIONS
6202 @{
6203 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6204 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6205 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6206 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6207 @dots{}
6208 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6209 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6210 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6211 @dots{}
6212 @}
6213 @end group
6214 @end example
6215
6216 @node VERSION
6217 @section VERSION Command
6218 @kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6219 @cindex symbol versions
6220 @cindex version script
6221 @cindex versions of symbols
6222 The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6223 only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6224 symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6225 a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6226 shared library.
6227
6228 You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6229 you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6230 also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6231
6232 The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6233 @smallexample
6234 VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6235 @end smallexample
6236
6237 The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6238 Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6239 version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6240 version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6241 version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6242 scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6243 library.
6244
6245 The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6246 examples.
6247
6248 @smallexample
6249 VERS_1.1 @{
6250 global:
6251 foo1;
6252 local:
6253 old*;
6254 original*;
6255 new*;
6256 @};
6257
6258 VERS_1.2 @{
6259 foo2;
6260 @} VERS_1.1;
6261
6262 VERS_2.0 @{
6263 bar1; bar2;
6264 extern "C++" @{
6265 ns::*;
6266 "f(int, double)";
6267 @};
6268 @} VERS_1.2;
6269 @end smallexample
6270
6271 This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6272 version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6273 The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6274 a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
6275 of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6276 symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6277 is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6278 in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
6279 However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6280 name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
6281
6282 Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6283 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6284 to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6285
6286 Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6287 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6288 and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6289
6290 When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6291 specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6292 unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
6293 unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
6294 somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6295 wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6296 wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6297 set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6298 ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
6299
6300 The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6301 they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6302 could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6303 However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6304
6305 Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6306 in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6307 symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6308 won't.
6309
6310 @smallexample
6311 @{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
6312 @end smallexample
6313
6314 When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6315 symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6316 requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6317 shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6318 loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6319 linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6320 application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6321 way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6322 all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6323 search for each symbol reference.
6324
6325 The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6326 doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6327 that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6328 functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6329 the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6330 required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6331 that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6332 versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6333 the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6334
6335 There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6336 first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6337 source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6338 script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6339 maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6340 @smallexample
6341 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6342 @end smallexample
6343 @noindent
6344 in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6345 be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6346 The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6347 @samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6348 takes precedence over a version script.
6349
6350 The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6351 function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6352 an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6353 version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6354 linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6355
6356 To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6357 source file. Here is an example:
6358
6359 @smallexample
6360 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6361 __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6362 __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6363 __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6364 @end smallexample
6365
6366 In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6367 unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6368 example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6369 @samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6370
6371 When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6372 some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6373 this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6374 @samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6375 declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6376 you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6377
6378 If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6379 within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6380 (i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6381 specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6382
6383 You can also specify the language in the version script:
6384
6385 @smallexample
6386 VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6387 @end smallexample
6388
6389 The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6390 The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6391 demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6392 patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6393 @samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6394
6395 Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6396 described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6397 or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6398 the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6399 whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6400 cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6401 might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6402 should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6403 expect when you upgrade.
6404
6405 @node Expressions
6406 @section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6407 @cindex expressions
6408 @cindex arithmetic
6409 The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6410 that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6411 places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6412 evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6413 size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6414 otherwise 64 bits.
6415
6416 You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6417
6418 The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6419 expressions.
6420
6421 @menu
6422 * Constants:: Constants
6423 * Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
6424 * Symbols:: Symbol Names
6425 * Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
6426 * Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6427 * Operators:: Operators
6428 * Evaluation:: Evaluation
6429 * Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6430 * Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6431 @end menu
6432
6433 @node Constants
6434 @subsection Constants
6435 @cindex integer notation
6436 @cindex constants in linker scripts
6437 All constants are integers.
6438
6439 As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6440 octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6441 hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6442 @samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6443 @samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6444 value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6445
6446 @cindex scaled integers
6447 @cindex K and M integer suffixes
6448 @cindex M and K integer suffixes
6449 @cindex suffixes for integers
6450 @cindex integer suffixes
6451 In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6452 constant by
6453 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6454 @ifnottex
6455 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6456 @code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6457 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6458 @end ifnottex
6459 @tex
6460 ${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6461 @end tex
6462 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6463 respectively. For example, the following
6464 all refer to the same quantity:
6465
6466 @smallexample
6467 _fourk_1 = 4K;
6468 _fourk_2 = 4096;
6469 _fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6470 _fourk_4 = 10000o;
6471 @end smallexample
6472
6473 Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6474 conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6475
6476 @node Symbolic Constants
6477 @subsection Symbolic Constants
6478 @cindex symbolic constants
6479 @kindex CONSTANT
6480 It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6481 the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6482
6483 @table @code
6484 @item MAXPAGESIZE
6485 @kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6486 The target's maximum page size.
6487
6488 @item COMMONPAGESIZE
6489 @kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6490 The target's default page size.
6491 @end table
6492
6493 So for example:
6494
6495 @smallexample
6496 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6497 @end smallexample
6498
6499 will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6500 supported by the target.
6501
6502 @node Symbols
6503 @subsection Symbol Names
6504 @cindex symbol names
6505 @cindex names
6506 @cindex quoted symbol names
6507 @kindex "
6508 Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6509 and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6510 Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6511 specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6512 keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6513 @smallexample
6514 "SECTION" = 9;
6515 "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6516 @end smallexample
6517
6518 Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6519 to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6520 whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6521
6522 @node Orphan Sections
6523 @subsection Orphan Sections
6524 @cindex orphan
6525 Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6526 are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6527 script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
6528 output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6529 in which to place the orphaned input section.
6530
6531 If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6532 an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6533 placed at the end of that output section.
6534
6535 If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6536 sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6537 name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6538 orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6539 one new output section.
6540
6541 If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6542 then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6543 in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6544 linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6545 attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6546 sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6547 support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6548
6549 The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6550 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6551 output sections an orphan is placed in.
6552
6553 @node Location Counter
6554 @subsection The Location Counter
6555 @kindex .
6556 @cindex dot
6557 @cindex location counter
6558 @cindex current output location
6559 The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6560 current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6561 location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6562 within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6563 anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6564
6565 @cindex holes
6566 Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6567 moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
6568 location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6569 and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6570 doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6571
6572 @smallexample
6573 SECTIONS
6574 @{
6575 output :
6576 @{
6577 file1(.text)
6578 . = . + 1000;
6579 file2(.text)
6580 . += 1000;
6581 file3(.text)
6582 @} = 0x12345678;
6583 @}
6584 @end smallexample
6585 @noindent
6586 In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6587 located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6588 followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6589 @file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6590 @samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6591 specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6592
6593 @cindex dot inside sections
6594 Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6595 current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6596 statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6597 absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6598 however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6599 not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6600
6601 @smallexample
6602 SECTIONS
6603 @{
6604 . = 0x100
6605 .text: @{
6606 *(.text)
6607 . = 0x200
6608 @}
6609 . = 0x500
6610 .data: @{
6611 *(.data)
6612 . += 0x600
6613 @}
6614 @}
6615 @end smallexample
6616
6617 The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6618 and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6619 the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6620 much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6621 move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6622 and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6623 the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6624 the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6625
6626 @cindex dot outside sections
6627 Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6628 output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6629 needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6630
6631 @smallexample
6632 SECTIONS
6633 @{
6634 start_of_text = . ;
6635 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6636 end_of_text = . ;
6637
6638 start_of_data = . ;
6639 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6640 end_of_data = . ;
6641 @}
6642 @end smallexample
6643
6644 If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6645 not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6646 between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6647 should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6648 blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6649 the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6650 sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6651 statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6652 special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6653 place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6654 as follows:
6655
6656 @smallexample
6657 SECTIONS
6658 @{
6659 start_of_text = . ;
6660 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6661 end_of_text = . ;
6662
6663 start_of_data = . ;
6664 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6665 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6666 end_of_data = . ;
6667 @}
6668 @end smallexample
6669
6670 This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6671 @code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6672 placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6673 assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6674 a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6675 section. So you could write:
6676
6677 @smallexample
6678 SECTIONS
6679 @{
6680 start_of_text = . ;
6681 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6682 end_of_text = . ;
6683
6684 . = . ;
6685 start_of_data = . ;
6686 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6687 end_of_data = . ;
6688 @}
6689 @end smallexample
6690
6691 Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6692 @code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6693
6694 @need 2000
6695 @node Operators
6696 @subsection Operators
6697 @cindex operators for arithmetic
6698 @cindex arithmetic operators
6699 @cindex precedence in expressions
6700 The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6701 the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6702 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6703 @ifnottex
6704 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6705 @smallexample
6706 precedence associativity Operators Notes
6707 (highest)
6708 1 left ! - ~ (1)
6709 2 left * / %
6710 3 left + -
6711 4 left >> <<
6712 5 left == != > < <= >=
6713 6 left &
6714 7 left |
6715 8 left &&
6716 9 left ||
6717 10 right ? :
6718 11 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6719 (lowest)
6720 @end smallexample
6721 Notes:
6722 (1) Prefix operators
6723 (2) @xref{Assignments}.
6724 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6725 @end ifnottex
6726 @tex
6727 \vskip \baselineskip
6728 %"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6729 \hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6730 \hrule
6731 \halign
6732 {\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6733 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6734 &Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6735 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6736 \noalign{\hrule}
6737 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6738 &highest&&&&&\cr
6739 % '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6740 &1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
6741 &2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6742 &3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6743 &4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6744 &5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6745 &6&&left&&\&&\cr
6746 &7&&left&&|&\cr
6747 &8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6748 &9&&left&&||&\cr
6749 &10&&right&&? :&\cr
6750 &11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6751 &lowest&&&&&\cr
6752 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6753 \hrule}
6754 @end tex
6755 @iftex
6756 {
6757 @obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6758 @dag@quad Prefix operators.
6759 @ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6760 }
6761 @end iftex
6762 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6763
6764 @node Evaluation
6765 @subsection Evaluation
6766 @cindex lazy evaluation
6767 @cindex expression evaluation order
6768 The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6769 an expression when absolutely necessary.
6770
6771 The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6772 address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6773 regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6774 as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6775
6776 However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6777 until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6778 other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6779 for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6780
6781 The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6782 assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6783 allocation.
6784
6785 Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6786 @samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6787
6788 If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6789 available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6790 following
6791 @smallexample
6792 @group
6793 SECTIONS
6794 @{
6795 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
6796 @{ *(.text) @}
6797 @}
6798 @end group
6799 @end smallexample
6800 @noindent
6801 will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6802 address}.
6803
6804 @node Expression Section
6805 @subsection The Section of an Expression
6806 @cindex expression sections
6807 @cindex absolute expressions
6808 @cindex relative expressions
6809 @cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6810 @cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6811 @cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
6812 Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6813 relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6814 using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6815 value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6816 symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6817 operations.
6818
6819 Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6820 section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6821 address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6822 @code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6823 functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
6824 One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6825 (@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
6826 differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6827 versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6828 section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6829 Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
6830 absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6831 given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6832 everywhere.
6833
6834 In the following simple example,
6835
6836 @smallexample
6837 @group
6838 SECTIONS
6839 @{
6840 . = 0x100;
6841 __executable_start = 0x100;
6842 .data :
6843 @{
6844 . = 0x10;
6845 __data_start = 0x10;
6846 *(.data)
6847 @}
6848 @dots{}
6849 @}
6850 @end group
6851 @end smallexample
6852
6853 both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6854 address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6855 @code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6856 section in the second two assignments.
6857
6858 For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6859 addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
6860
6861 @itemize @bullet
6862 @item
6863 Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6864 operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6865 absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6866 @item
6867 Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6868 relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6869 and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6870 @item
6871 Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6872 in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6873 address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6874 before applying the operator.
6875 @end itemize
6876
6877 The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6878
6879 @itemize @bullet
6880 @item
6881 An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6882 @item
6883 The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6884 @item
6885 The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
6886 relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
6887 (after above conversions) is also a number when
6888 @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6889 but an absolute address otherwise.
6890 @item
6891 The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6892 relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6893 section as the relative operand(s).
6894 @item
6895 The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6896 conversions) is an absolute address.
6897 @end itemize
6898
6899 You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6900 to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6901 create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6902 section @samp{.data}:
6903 @smallexample
6904 SECTIONS
6905 @{
6906 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6907 @}
6908 @end smallexample
6909 @noindent
6910 If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6911 @samp{.data} section.
6912
6913 Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6914 particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6915
6916 @node Builtin Functions
6917 @subsection Builtin Functions
6918 @cindex functions in expressions
6919 The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6920 use in linker script expressions.
6921
6922 @table @code
6923 @item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6924 @kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6925 @cindex expression, absolute
6926 Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6927 of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6928 value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6929 normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6930
6931 @item ADDR(@var{section})
6932 @kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6933 @cindex section address in expression
6934 Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
6935 script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
6936 the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6937 @code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6938 @code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6939 the other two will be absolute:
6940 @smallexample
6941 @group
6942 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6943 .output1 :
6944 @{
6945 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6946 @dots{}
6947 @}
6948 .output :
6949 @{
6950 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6951 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6952 @}
6953 @dots{} @}
6954 @end group
6955 @end smallexample
6956
6957 @item ALIGN(@var{align})
6958 @itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6959 @kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6960 @kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6961 @cindex round up location counter
6962 @cindex align location counter
6963 @cindex round up expression
6964 @cindex align expression
6965 Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6966 to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6967 doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6968 arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6969 expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
6970 equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
6971
6972 Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6973 next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6974 variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6975 input sections:
6976 @smallexample
6977 @group
6978 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6979 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6980 *(.data)
6981 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6982 @}
6983 @dots{} @}
6984 @end group
6985 @end smallexample
6986 @noindent
6987 The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6988 a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6989 a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6990 of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6991
6992 The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6993
6994 @item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6995 @kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6996 @cindex section alignment
6997 Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6998 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6999 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7000 the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
7001 value in that section.
7002 @smallexample
7003 @group
7004 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7005 .output @{
7006 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
7007 @dots{}
7008 @}
7009 @dots{} @}
7010 @end group
7011 @end smallexample
7012
7013 @item BLOCK(@var{exp})
7014 @kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
7015 This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
7016 scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
7017 section.
7018
7019 @item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7020 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7021 This is equivalent to either
7022 @smallexample
7023 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
7024 @end smallexample
7025 or
7026 @smallexample
7027 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
7028 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
7029 @end smallexample
7030 @noindent
7031 depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
7032 for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
7033 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
7034 If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
7035 memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
7036 bytes in the on-disk file.
7037
7038 This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
7039 any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
7040 @var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
7041 be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
7042 running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
7043 that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
7044 page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
7045
7046 @noindent
7047 Example:
7048 @smallexample
7049 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
7050 @end smallexample
7051
7052 @item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7053 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7054 This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
7055 evaluation purposes.
7056
7057 @smallexample
7058 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
7059 @end smallexample
7060
7061 @item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7062 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7063 This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
7064 @samp{-z relro} option is used.
7065 When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7066 does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
7067 @var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7068 argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
7069 script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
7070 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7071 padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7072 section alignment.
7073
7074 @smallexample
7075 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7076 @end smallexample
7077
7078 @item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7079 @kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7080 @cindex symbol defaults
7081 Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
7082 defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7083 return 0. You can use this function to provide
7084 default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
7085 shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7086 the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7087 existed, its value is preserved:
7088
7089 @smallexample
7090 @group
7091 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7092 .text : @{
7093 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7094 @dots{}
7095 @}
7096 @dots{}
7097 @}
7098 @end group
7099 @end smallexample
7100
7101 @item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7102 @kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7103 Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7104
7105 @item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7106 @kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7107 @cindex section load address in expression
7108 Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
7109 Section LMA}).
7110
7111 @item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7112 @kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7113 Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7114 @code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7115
7116 @kindex MAX
7117 @item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7118 Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7119
7120 @kindex MIN
7121 @item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7122 Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7123
7124 @item NEXT(@var{exp})
7125 @kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7126 @cindex unallocated address, next
7127 Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7128 This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7129 use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7130 output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7131
7132 @item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7133 @kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7134 Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7135
7136 @item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7137 @kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7138 Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
7139 value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7140 @samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7141 will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7142 can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7143 ``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
7144 name.
7145
7146 @item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7147 @kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7148 @cindex section size
7149 Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7150 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
7151 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7152 @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
7153 @smallexample
7154 @group
7155 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7156 .output @{
7157 .start = . ;
7158 @dots{}
7159 .end = . ;
7160 @}
7161 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7162 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7163 @dots{} @}
7164 @end group
7165 @end smallexample
7166
7167 @item SIZEOF_HEADERS
7168 @kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7169 @cindex header size
7170 Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7171 information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7172 this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7173 choose, to facilitate paging.
7174
7175 @cindex not enough room for program headers
7176 @cindex program headers, not enough room
7177 When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7178 @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7179 number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7180 addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7181 additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7182 room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7183 the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7184 script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7185 you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7186 command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7187 @end table
7188
7189 @node Implicit Linker Scripts
7190 @section Implicit Linker Scripts
7191 @cindex implicit linker scripts
7192 If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7193 an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7194 linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7195 linker will report an error.
7196
7197 An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7198
7199 Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7200 assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7201 commands.
7202
7203 Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7204 at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7205 read. This can affect archive searching.
7206
7207 @node Plugins
7208 @chapter Linker Plugins
7209
7210 @cindex plugins
7211 @cindex linker plugins
7212 The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7213 For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7214 support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7215
7216 Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7217 be added here later.
7218
7219 Plugins are enabled via the use of the @option{-plugin @var{name}}
7220 command line option. @xref{Options}
7221
7222 @menu
7223 * libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7224 @end menu
7225
7226 @node libdep Plugin
7227 @section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7228 @cindex static library dependencies
7229 Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7230 just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7231 optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7232 within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7233 rose to ascendance.
7234
7235 One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7236 multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7237 dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7238 library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7239 referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7240 link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7241 libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7242 explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7243
7244 The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7245 to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7246 plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7247 dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7248 and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7249 command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7250 utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7251 being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7252 archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7253
7254 For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7255 library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7256 the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7257
7258 @smallexample
7259 -L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7260 @end smallexample
7261
7262 @ifset GENERIC
7263 @node Machine Dependent
7264 @chapter Machine Dependent Features
7265
7266 @cindex machine dependencies
7267 @command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7268 sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
7269 functionality are not listed.
7270
7271 @menu
7272 @ifset H8300
7273 * H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7274 @end ifset
7275 @ifset M68HC11
7276 * M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7277 @end ifset
7278 @ifset ARM
7279 * ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7280 @end ifset
7281 @ifset HPPA
7282 * HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7283 @end ifset
7284 @ifset M68K
7285 * M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7286 @end ifset
7287 @ifset MIPS
7288 * MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7289 @end ifset
7290 @ifset MMIX
7291 * MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
7292 @end ifset
7293 @ifset MSP430
7294 * MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
7295 @end ifset
7296 @ifset NDS32
7297 * NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7298 @end ifset
7299 @ifset NIOSII
7300 * Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7301 @end ifset
7302 @ifset POWERPC
7303 * PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7304 @end ifset
7305 @ifset POWERPC64
7306 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7307 @end ifset
7308 @ifset S/390
7309 * S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7310 @end ifset
7311 @ifset SPU
7312 * SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7313 @end ifset
7314 @ifset TICOFF
7315 * TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
7316 @end ifset
7317 @ifset WIN32
7318 * WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7319 @end ifset
7320 @ifset XTENSA
7321 * Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7322 @end ifset
7323 @end menu
7324 @end ifset
7325
7326 @ifset H8300
7327 @ifclear GENERIC
7328 @raisesections
7329 @end ifclear
7330
7331 @node H8/300
7332 @section @command{ld} and the H8/300
7333
7334 @cindex H8/300 support
7335 For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
7336 you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7337
7338 @table @emph
7339 @cindex relaxing on H8/300
7340 @item relaxing address modes
7341 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7342 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7343 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7344 respectively.
7345
7346 @cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7347 @item synthesizing instructions
7348 @c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
7349 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
7350 sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7351 page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7352 (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7353 @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7354 top page of memory).
7355
7356 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7357 indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7358 displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7359 the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7360 @code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7361 whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7362 range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7363
7364 @item bit manipulation instructions
7365 @command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
7366 biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
7367 which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7368 page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7369 (That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
7370 @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7371 the top page of memory).
7372
7373 @item system control instructions
7374 @command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
7375 32 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
7376 changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7377 (That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7378 @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7379 the top page of memory).
7380 @end table
7381
7382 @ifclear GENERIC
7383 @lowersections
7384 @end ifclear
7385 @end ifset
7386
7387 @ifclear GENERIC
7388 @ifset Renesas
7389 @c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7390 @c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7391 @node Renesas
7392 @chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7393
7394 @command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7395 H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7396 options are required for these chips.
7397 @end ifset
7398 @end ifclear
7399
7400 @ifset ARM
7401 @ifclear GENERIC
7402 @raisesections
7403 @end ifclear
7404
7405 @ifset M68HC11
7406 @ifclear GENERIC
7407 @raisesections
7408 @end ifclear
7409
7410 @node M68HC11/68HC12
7411 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7412
7413 @cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7414
7415 @subsection Linker Relaxation
7416
7417 For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7418 optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7419
7420 @table @emph
7421 @cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7422 @item relaxing address modes
7423 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7424 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7425 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7426 respectively.
7427
7428 @command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7429 transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7430 page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7431
7432 @item relaxing gcc instruction group
7433 When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7434 of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7435 addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7436 @code{bset} instructions.
7437
7438 @end table
7439
7440 @subsection Trampoline Generation
7441
7442 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7443 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7444 For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7445 call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7446 will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7447 trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7448 case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7449 point to the function trampoline.
7450
7451 @ifclear GENERIC
7452 @lowersections
7453 @end ifclear
7454 @end ifset
7455
7456 @node ARM
7457 @section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7458
7459 @cindex ARM interworking support
7460 @kindex --support-old-code
7461 For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7462 between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
7463 been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7464 line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7465 libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7466 option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7467 given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7468 which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7469 the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7470 non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7471
7472 @cindex thumb entry point
7473 @cindex entry point, thumb
7474 @kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7475 The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7476 @samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7477 But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7478 branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7479 executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7480
7481 @cindex PE import table prefixing
7482 @kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7483 The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7484 the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7485 element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7486 import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7487
7488 @cindex BE8
7489 @kindex --be8
7490 The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7491 executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7492 objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7493 option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7494 little-endian code.
7495
7496 @cindex TARGET1
7497 @kindex --target1-rel
7498 @kindex --target1-abs
7499 The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7500 @samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7501 or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7502 and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7503
7504 @cindex TARGET2
7505 @kindex --target2=@var{type}
7506 The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7507 @samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7508 meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7509 @table @samp
7510 @item rel
7511 @samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7512 @item abs
7513 @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
7514 @item got-rel
7515 @samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7516 @end table
7517
7518 @cindex FIX_V4BX
7519 @kindex --fix-v4bx
7520 The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7521 specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7522 interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7523 also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7524
7525 In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7526 linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7527 @code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7528
7529 In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7530 relocations are ignored.
7531
7532 @cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7533 @kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7534 Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7535 relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7536
7537 @smallexample
7538 TST rM, #1
7539 MOVEQ PC, rM
7540 BX Rn
7541 @end smallexample
7542
7543 This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7544 and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7545 condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7546
7547 @cindex USE_BLX
7548 @kindex --use-blx
7549 The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7550 BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7551 situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7552 code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7553 each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7554
7555 @cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7556 @kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7557 The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7558 bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7559 instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7560 to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7561 the support code can read the intended values.
7562
7563 The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7564 intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7565 and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7566 intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7567 full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7568 you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7569
7570 If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7571 enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7572 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7573 mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7574 vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7575 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7576
7577 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7578 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7579 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7580 first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7581 instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7582 the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7583 are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7584
7585 @cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7586 @kindex --fix-arm1176
7587 @kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7588 The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7589 in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7590 are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
7591 unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7592
7593 Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7594 Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7595 http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7596
7597 @cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7598 @kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7599
7600 The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7601 workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7602 the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7603 off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7604 the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7605 core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7606 integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7607 VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7608
7609 The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7610 necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7611
7612 The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7613 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7614 STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7615 linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7616 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7617
7618 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7619 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7620 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7621 replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7622 branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7623 then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7624
7625 The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7626 the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7627
7628 The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7629 they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7630 there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7631 occurs.
7632
7633 The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7634 PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7635 large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7636 cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7637 occurs.
7638
7639 @cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7640 @kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7641 The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7642 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7643 enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7644 linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7645 using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7646 not be diagnosed.
7647
7648 @cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7649 @kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7650 The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7651 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7652 @code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7653 linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7654 using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7655
7656 @cindex PIC_VENEER
7657 @kindex --pic-veneer
7658 The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7659 ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7660 is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7661 @samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7662
7663 @cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7664 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7665 The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7666 code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7667 perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7668 placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7669 controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7670 The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7671 duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
7672 group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7673 code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7674 where they should be placed.
7675
7676 The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7677 @option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7678 placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7679 branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7680 placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7681 value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7682 exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7683 A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7684 linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7685 from the input sections.
7686
7687 The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7688 @samp{N = +1}.
7689
7690 Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7691 only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7692 otherwise.
7693
7694 @cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7695 @kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7696 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7697 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7698
7699 The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7700
7701 @cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7702 @kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7703 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7704 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7705
7706 Please contact ARM for further details.
7707
7708 @kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7709 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7710 @cindex Merging exidx entries
7711 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7712
7713 @kindex --long-plt
7714 @cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7715 The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7716 which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7717 entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7718
7719 @kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7720 @cindex AArch64 rela addend
7721 The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7722 link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7723
7724 @cindex Placement of SG veneers
7725 All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7726 Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7727 @samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7728 veneers in memory.
7729
7730 @kindex --cmse-implib
7731 @cindex Secure gateway import library
7732 The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7733 specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7734 secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7735 executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7736
7737 @kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7738 @cindex Input import library
7739 The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7740 must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7741 given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7742 in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7743 @samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7744 library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7745 library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7746 for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7747 specified.
7748
7749 @ifclear GENERIC
7750 @lowersections
7751 @end ifclear
7752 @end ifset
7753
7754 @ifset HPPA
7755 @ifclear GENERIC
7756 @raisesections
7757 @end ifclear
7758
7759 @node HPPA ELF32
7760 @section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7761 @cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7762 @kindex --multi-subspace
7763 When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7764 import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7765 The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7766 stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7767 multiple sub-spaces.
7768
7769 @cindex HPPA stub grouping
7770 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7771 Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7772 stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7773 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7774 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7775 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7776 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7777 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7778 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7779 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7780 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7781 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7782 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7783 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7784 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7785
7786 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7787 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7788 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7789 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7790
7791 @ifclear GENERIC
7792 @lowersections
7793 @end ifclear
7794 @end ifset
7795
7796 @ifset M68K
7797 @ifclear GENERIC
7798 @raisesections
7799 @end ifclear
7800
7801 @node M68K
7802 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7803
7804 @cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7805 @kindex --got=@var{type}
7806 The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7807 The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7808 @samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7809 the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7810 @samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7811 entries only at non-negative offsets.
7812 @samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7813 entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7814 support such GOTs.
7815 @samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7816 output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7817 file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7818 files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7819
7820 @ifclear GENERIC
7821 @lowersections
7822 @end ifclear
7823 @end ifset
7824
7825 @ifset MIPS
7826 @ifclear GENERIC
7827 @raisesections
7828 @end ifclear
7829
7830 @node MIPS
7831 @section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7832
7833 @cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7834 @kindex --insn32
7835 @kindex --no-insn32
7836 The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7837 microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7838 in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7839 used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7840 or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7841 including 16-bit ones where possible.
7842
7843 @cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7844 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7845 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7846 The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7847 control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7848 @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7849 relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7850 calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7851 relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7852 instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7853 or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7854 the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7855
7856 @ifclear GENERIC
7857 @lowersections
7858 @end ifclear
7859 @end ifset
7860
7861 @ifset MMIX
7862 @ifclear GENERIC
7863 @raisesections
7864 @end ifclear
7865
7866 @node MMIX
7867 @section @code{ld} and MMIX
7868 For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7869 @code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7870 understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7871 can translate between the two formats.
7872
7873 There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7874 Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7875 registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7876 equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7877 @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7878 global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7879 this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7880 symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7881
7882 Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7883 @code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7884 The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7885 of a section.
7886
7887 Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7888 are left out from an mmo file.
7889
7890 @ifclear GENERIC
7891 @lowersections
7892 @end ifclear
7893 @end ifset
7894
7895 @ifset MSP430
7896 @ifclear GENERIC
7897 @raisesections
7898 @end ifclear
7899
7900 @node MSP430
7901 @section @code{ld} and MSP430
7902 For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7903 will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7904 just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7905
7906 @cindex MSP430 extra sections
7907 The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7908
7909 @table @code
7910 @item @samp{.vectors}
7911 Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7912
7913 @item @samp{.bootloader}
7914 Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7915 in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7916
7917 @item @samp{.infomem}
7918 Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7919 this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7920
7921 @item @samp{.infomemnobits}
7922 This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7923 in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7924
7925 @item @samp{.noinit}
7926 Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7927
7928 The last two sections are used by gcc.
7929 @end table
7930
7931 @table @option
7932 @cindex MSP430 Options
7933 @kindex --code-region
7934 @item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7935 This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7936 argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7937 using this option.
7938
7939 @kindex --data-region
7940 @item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7941 This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7942 [either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7943 for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7944
7945 @kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7946 @item --disable-sec-transformation
7947 Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7948 and @code{--data-region} options.
7949 This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7950 wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7951 not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7952 @end table
7953
7954 @ifclear GENERIC
7955 @lowersections
7956 @end ifclear
7957 @end ifset
7958
7959 @ifset NDS32
7960 @ifclear GENERIC
7961 @raisesections
7962 @end ifclear
7963
7964 @node NDS32
7965 @section @code{ld} and NDS32
7966 @kindex relaxing on NDS32
7967 For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7968 relaxes objects according to these options.
7969
7970 @table @code
7971 @item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7972 Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7973
7974 @item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7975 Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7976
7977 @item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7978 Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7979
7980 @item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7981 Export the EX9 table after linking.
7982
7983 @item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7984 Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7985
7986 @item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7987 Update the existing EX9 table.
7988
7989 @item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7990 Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7991
7992 @item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7993 Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7994
7995 @item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7996 Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7997
7998 @item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7999 Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
8000 @end table
8001
8002 @ifclear GENERIC
8003 @lowersections
8004 @end ifclear
8005 @end ifset
8006
8007 @ifset NIOSII
8008 @ifclear GENERIC
8009 @raisesections
8010 @end ifclear
8011
8012 @node Nios II
8013 @section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
8014 @cindex Nios II call relaxation
8015 @kindex --relax on Nios II
8016
8017 Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
8018 transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
8019 which may result in @command{ld} giving
8020 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8021 The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
8022 trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
8023 outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
8024 trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
8025 be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
8026 larger than 256MB.
8027
8028 The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
8029 is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
8030 @option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
8031 locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
8032 source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
8033 register as a temporary.
8034
8035 Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
8036 relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
8037 option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
8038
8039 @ifclear GENERIC
8040 @lowersections
8041 @end ifclear
8042 @end ifset
8043
8044 @ifset POWERPC
8045 @ifclear GENERIC
8046 @raisesections
8047 @end ifclear
8048
8049 @node PowerPC ELF32
8050 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
8051 @cindex PowerPC long branches
8052 @kindex --relax on PowerPC
8053 Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
8054 displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
8055 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8056 @samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
8057 the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
8058 section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
8059 section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
8060 @samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
8061 both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
8062 considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
8063
8064 @cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8065 @table @option
8066 @cindex PowerPC PLT
8067 @kindex --bss-plt
8068 @item --bss-plt
8069 Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8070 generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8071 the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8072 writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
8073 @command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8074 PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8075 compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8076 BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8077
8078 @kindex --secure-plt
8079 @item --secure-plt
8080 @command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8081 @samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8082 when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8083 layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8084 style BSS PLT.
8085
8086 @cindex PowerPC GOT
8087 @kindex --sdata-got
8088 @item --sdata-got
8089 The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8090 sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
8091 @code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8092 section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
8093 @code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
8094 @code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8095 @samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
8096 @code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8097 PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8098 pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
8099 GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8100 really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8101
8102 @cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8103 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8104 @item --emit-stub-syms
8105 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8106 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8107
8108 @cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8109 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8110 @item --no-tls-optimize
8111 PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8112 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8113 disable the optimization.
8114 @end table
8115
8116 @ifclear GENERIC
8117 @lowersections
8118 @end ifclear
8119 @end ifset
8120
8121 @ifset POWERPC64
8122 @ifclear GENERIC
8123 @raisesections
8124 @end ifclear
8125
8126 @node PowerPC64 ELF64
8127 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8128
8129 @cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8130 @table @option
8131 @cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8132 @kindex --stub-group-size
8133 @item --stub-group-size
8134 Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8135 by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8136 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8137 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8138 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8139 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8140 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8141 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8142 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8143 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8144 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8145 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8146 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8147 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8148
8149 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8150 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8151 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8152 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8153
8154 @cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8155 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8156 @item --emit-stub-syms
8157 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8158 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8159
8160 @cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8161 @kindex --dotsyms
8162 @kindex --no-dotsyms
8163 @item --dotsyms
8164 @itemx --no-dotsyms
8165 These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8166 in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8167 function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8168 code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8169 properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8170 to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8171 @samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8172 dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8173 feature.
8174
8175 @cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8176 @kindex --save-restore-funcs
8177 @kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
8178 @item --save-restore-funcs
8179 @itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
8180 These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8181 provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8182 @samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8183 function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8184 link.
8185
8186 @cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8187 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8188 @item --no-tls-optimize
8189 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8190 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8191 disable the optimization.
8192
8193 @cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8194 @kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8195 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8196 @kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8197 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
8198 @item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8199 @itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8200 These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
8201 stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8202 an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8203 @code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
8204 stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8205 generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8206 __tls_get_addr_opt.
8207 Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8208 much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8209 an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8210 will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8211 @option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8212 and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8213 this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8214 Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
8215 @option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
8216 register saves.
8217
8218 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8219 @kindex --no-opd-optimize
8220 @item --no-opd-optimize
8221 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8222 corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
8223 the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
8224 Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8225
8226 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8227 @kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8228 @item --non-overlapping-opd
8229 Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8230 @code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8231 the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8232 entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8233
8234 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8235 @kindex --no-toc-optimize
8236 @item --no-toc-optimize
8237 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8238 entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8239 reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8240 marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8241 marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8242 relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8243 unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8244 reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8245 discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8246 reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8247 code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8248 optimization.
8249
8250 @cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8251 @kindex --no-inline-optimize
8252 @item --no-inline-optimize
8253 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8254 marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8255 @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8256 a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8257 locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8258 disables that optimization.
8259
8260 @cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8261 @kindex --no-multi-toc
8262 @item --no-multi-toc
8263 If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8264 @code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8265 where TOC
8266 entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8267 total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8268 grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8269 TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8270 calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8271 help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
8272 64K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8273 Use this option to turn off this feature.
8274
8275 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8276 @kindex --no-toc-sort
8277 @item --no-toc-sort
8278 By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8279 happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8280 placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8281 with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8282 referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8283 @code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8284 results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8285 off this feature.
8286
8287 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8288 @kindex --plt-align
8289 @kindex --no-plt-align
8290 @item --plt-align
8291 @itemx --no-plt-align
8292 Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
8293 aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8294 boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8295 specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8296 specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8297 if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8298 PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
8299
8300 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8301 @kindex --plt-static-chain
8302 @kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8303 @item --plt-static-chain
8304 @itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8305 Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8306 chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8307 chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8308
8309 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8310 @kindex --plt-thread-safe
8311 @kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8312 @item --plt-thread-safe
8313 @itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
8314 With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8315 lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8316 another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8317 order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8318 memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8319 barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8320 looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8321 seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8322 default behaviour.
8323
8324 @cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8325 @kindex --plt-localentry
8326 @kindex --no-plt-localentry
8327 @item --plt-localentry
8328 @itemx --no-localentry
8329 ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8330 ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8331 (the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8332 Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8333 or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8334 functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8335 in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
8336 interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8337 including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8338 to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8339 complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8340 care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
8341
8342 @cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8343 @kindex --power10-stubs
8344 @kindex --no-power10-stubs
8345 @item --power10-stubs
8346 @itemx --no-power10-stubs
8347 When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8348 relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
8349 linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8350 for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8351 power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
8352 power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8353 allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
8354 @option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8355 auto mode.
8356 @end table
8357
8358 @ifclear GENERIC
8359 @lowersections
8360 @end ifclear
8361 @end ifset
8362
8363 @ifset S/390
8364 @ifclear GENERIC
8365 @raisesections
8366 @end ifclear
8367
8368 @node S/390 ELF
8369 @section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8370
8371 @cindex S/390 ELF options
8372 @table @option
8373
8374 @cindex S/390
8375 @kindex --s390-pgste
8376 @item --s390-pgste
8377 This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8378 segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8379 binaries marked that way.
8380 @end table
8381
8382 @ifclear GENERIC
8383 @lowersections
8384 @end ifclear
8385 @end ifset
8386
8387 @ifset SPU
8388 @ifclear GENERIC
8389 @raisesections
8390 @end ifclear
8391
8392 @node SPU ELF
8393 @section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8394
8395 @cindex SPU ELF options
8396 @table @option
8397
8398 @cindex SPU plugins
8399 @kindex --plugin
8400 @item --plugin
8401 This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8402
8403 @cindex SPU overlays
8404 @kindex --no-overlays
8405 @item --no-overlays
8406 Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8407 regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8408 @command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8409 turns off all this special overlay handling.
8410
8411 @cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8412 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8413 @item --emit-stub-syms
8414 This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8415 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8416
8417 @cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8418 @kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8419 @item --extra-overlay-stubs
8420 This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8421 function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8422 on calls to non-overlay regions.
8423
8424 @cindex SPU local store size
8425 @kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8426 @item --local-store=lo:hi
8427 @command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8428 the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8429 range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8430
8431 @cindex SPU
8432 @kindex --stack-analysis
8433 @item --stack-analysis
8434 SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8435 unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8436 under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8437 @command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8438 @command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8439 determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8440 for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8441 for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8442 for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8443 find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8444 and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8445 under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8446 dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8447 is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8448 and calls will be given.
8449
8450 @cindex SPU
8451 @kindex --emit-stack-syms
8452 @item --emit-stack-syms
8453 This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8454 in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8455 These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8456 functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8457 functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8458 such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8459 The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8460 @code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8461 @end table
8462
8463 @ifclear GENERIC
8464 @lowersections
8465 @end ifclear
8466 @end ifset
8467
8468 @ifset TICOFF
8469 @ifclear GENERIC
8470 @raisesections
8471 @end ifclear
8472
8473 @node TI COFF
8474 @section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8475 @cindex TI COFF versions
8476 @kindex --format=@var{version}
8477 The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8478 TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8479 also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8480 format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8481 header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8482
8483 @ifclear GENERIC
8484 @lowersections
8485 @end ifclear
8486 @end ifset
8487
8488 @ifset WIN32
8489 @ifclear GENERIC
8490 @raisesections
8491 @end ifclear
8492
8493 @node WIN32
8494 @section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8495
8496 This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8497 See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8498 command-line options mentioned here.
8499
8500 @table @emph
8501 @cindex import libraries
8502 @item import libraries
8503 The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8504 libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
8505 regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8506 archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8507 support for creating such libraries provided with the
8508 @samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8509
8510 @item exporting DLL symbols
8511 @cindex exporting DLL symbols
8512 The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8513
8514 @table @emph
8515 @item using auto-export functionality
8516 @cindex using auto-export functionality
8517 By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8518 which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8519
8520 @itemize
8521 @item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8522 @item --exclude-symbols
8523 @item --exclude-libs
8524 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8525 @item --version-script
8526 @end itemize
8527
8528 When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8529 (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8530 symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8531 often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8532 private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8533 options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8534 exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8535 final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8536
8537 If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8538 command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8539 if either of the following are true:
8540
8541 @itemize
8542 @item A DEF file is used.
8543 @item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8544 @end itemize
8545
8546 @item using a DEF file
8547 @cindex using a DEF file
8548 Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8549 an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8550 exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8551 name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8552 command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8553
8554 @example
8555 gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8556 @end example
8557
8558 Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8559 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8560
8561 Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8562
8563 @example
8564 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8565
8566 EXPORTS
8567 foo
8568 bar
8569 _bar = bar
8570 another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8571 var1 DATA
8572 doo = foo == foo2
8573 eoo DATA == var1
8574 @end example
8575
8576 This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8577 symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8578 alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8579 by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8580 @code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8581 @code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8582 export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8583 in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8584 symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8585
8586 The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8587 name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8588 the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8589
8590 When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8591 library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8592 @code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8593 executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8594
8595 With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8596 specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8597 non-default base address for the image.
8598
8599 If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8600 or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8601 filename specified on the command line.
8602
8603 The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8604
8605 @example
8606 EXPORTS
8607 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8608 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8609 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8610 @end example
8611
8612 Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8613 @samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8614 @samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8615 @samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8616 Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8617 @samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8618 string in import/export table for the symbol.
8619
8620 The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8621
8622 @code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8623 will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8624 by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8625 linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8626 library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8627
8628 @code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8629 The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8630 the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8631 @code{*_imp__foo}).
8632
8633 @code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8634 well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8635 read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8636 variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8637 the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8638 extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8639 application will behave unexpectedly.
8640
8641 @code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8642 it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8643 symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8644 API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8645 the DLL without an import library.
8646
8647 See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8648 other DEF file statements
8649
8650 @cindex creating a DEF file
8651 While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8652 with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8653
8654 @item Using decorations
8655 @cindex Using decorations
8656 Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8657 itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8658 declared as:
8659
8660 @example
8661 __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8662 __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8663 @end example
8664
8665 All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8666 any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8667 this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8668 the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8669
8670 Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8671 decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
8672 instead:
8673
8674 @example
8675 __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8676 __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8677 @end example
8678
8679 This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8680 when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8681 variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8682 code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
8683 of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8684 omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8685 @samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8686 information.
8687 @end table
8688
8689 @cindex automatic data imports
8690 @item automatic data imports
8691 The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8692 by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8693 compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8694 issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8695 code to these platforms, especially for large
8696 c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
8697 initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8698 decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8699 platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8700 command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8701 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8702 suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8703 trigger the feature's use.
8704
8705 auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
8706 additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8707
8708 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
8709 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8710
8711 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8712 occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8713 One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
8714 below.
8715
8716 @cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
8717 For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8718 object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8719 offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8720 field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8721 in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
8722 without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
8723 The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
8724 references.
8725
8726 The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8727 be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8728 themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8729 runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8730 compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8731 support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
8732 run without error on an older system.
8733
8734 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8735 enabled as needed.
8736
8737 @cindex direct linking to a dll
8738 @item direct linking to a dll
8739 The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8740 including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
8741 libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
8742 traditional import library method, especially when linking large
8743 libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8744 function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8745 though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
8746 storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
8747 tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
8748 large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8749
8750 Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
8751 @samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
8752 of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
8753 perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8754 select the dll instead of an import library.
8755
8756
8757 For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8758 to find, in the first directory of its search path,
8759
8760 @example
8761 libxxx.dll.a
8762 xxx.dll.a
8763 libxxx.a
8764 xxx.lib
8765 libxxx.lib
8766 cygxxx.dll (*)
8767 libxxx.dll
8768 xxx.dll
8769 @end example
8770
8771 before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8772
8773 (*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8774 where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8775 @samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8776 file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
8777 @samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8778
8779 Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8780 @samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
8781 was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8782 various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8783 could coexist on the same machine.
8784
8785 The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8786 applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
8787 libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
8788
8789 @example
8790 bin/
8791 cygxxx.dll
8792 lib/
8793 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
8794 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
8795 @end example
8796
8797 Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8798 done two ways:
8799
8800 1. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8801 @example
8802 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
8803 @end example
8804
8805 However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8806 (@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8807 @samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8808 not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8809
8810 2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8811 directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8812 should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8813 making the app/dll.
8814
8815 @example
8816 ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
8817 @end example
8818
8819 Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8820
8821 @example
8822 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
8823 @end example
8824
8825 This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8826 perfectly legal
8827
8828 @example
8829 bin/
8830 cygxxx-5.dll
8831 lib/
8832 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
8833 @end example
8834
8835 Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
8836 even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8837 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8838
8839 Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
8840 wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
8841
8842 1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8843 work with auto-imported data.
8844
8845 2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8846 import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8847 symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8848 for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8849 possible to do this without an import lib.
8850
8851 3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8852 critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8853 in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8854 stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8855
8856 So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
8857 true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8858 a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8859 binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
8860 massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8861 requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8862 will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
8863
8864 @item symbol aliasing
8865 @table @emph
8866 @item adding additional names
8867 Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
8868 A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8869 exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8870 when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
8871 import library. Consider the following DEF file:
8872
8873 @example
8874 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8875
8876 EXPORTS
8877 foo
8878 _foo = foo
8879 @end example
8880
8881 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8882
8883 Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8884 source code using the "weak" attribute:
8885
8886 @example
8887 void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
8888 void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
8889 @end example
8890
8891 See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8892 symbols.
8893
8894 @item renaming symbols
8895 Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
8896 kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
8897 @samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8898 DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
8899 created). In the following example:
8900
8901 @example
8902 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8903
8904 EXPORTS
8905 _foo = foo
8906 @end example
8907
8908 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8909 @samp{_foo}.
8910 @end table
8911
8912 Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
8913 unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
8914 If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
8915 @emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8916 that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8917 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8918 renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8919 to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8920 the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8921 In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
8922 which is probably not what you wanted.
8923
8924 @cindex weak externals
8925 @item weak externals
8926 The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8927 weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8928 defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8929 are three variants of weak externals:
8930 @itemize
8931 @item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8932 called lazy externals.
8933 @item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8934 This form is not presently implemented.
8935 @item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8936 implemented.
8937 @end itemize
8938 As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8939 are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8940 uses a default value.
8941
8942 @cindex aligned common symbols
8943 @item aligned common symbols
8944 As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8945 desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8946 the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8947 carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8948 by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8949 tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8950 but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8951 warnings about unknown linker directives.
8952
8953 @end table
8954
8955 @ifclear GENERIC
8956 @lowersections
8957 @end ifclear
8958 @end ifset
8959
8960 @ifset XTENSA
8961 @ifclear GENERIC
8962 @raisesections
8963 @end ifclear
8964
8965 @node Xtensa
8966 @section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8967
8968 @cindex Xtensa processors
8969 The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8970 @code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8971 specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8972 keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8973 example, with the command:
8974
8975 @smallexample
8976 SECTIONS
8977 @{
8978 .text : @{
8979 *(.literal .text)
8980 @}
8981 @}
8982 @end smallexample
8983
8984 @noindent
8985 @command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8986 and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8987 literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8988 interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8989 group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8990 files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8991 and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
8992
8993 @cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
8994 @cindex relaxing on Xtensa
8995 Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8996 provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8997 is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8998 literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8999 will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
9000 location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
9001 the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
9002 unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
9003 @code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
9004 range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
9005
9006 For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
9007 to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
9008 instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
9009 instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
9010 instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
9011 @code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
9012 hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
9013 By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
9014 switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
9015 density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
9016 instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
9017 performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
9018 linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
9019 a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
9020
9021 The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
9022 control the linker:
9023
9024 @cindex Xtensa options
9025 @table @option
9026 @item --size-opt
9027 When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
9028 more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
9029 no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
9030 alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
9031 preserve the correctness of the code.
9032
9033 @item --abi-windowed
9034 @itemx --abi-call0
9035 Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
9036 PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
9037 because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
9038 conventions.
9039 Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
9040 of the first input object.
9041 A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
9042 or the chosen output object ABI.
9043 @end table
9044
9045 @ifclear GENERIC
9046 @lowersections
9047 @end ifclear
9048 @end ifset
9049
9050 @ifclear SingleFormat
9051 @node BFD
9052 @chapter BFD
9053
9054 @cindex back end
9055 @cindex object file management
9056 @cindex object formats available
9057 @kindex objdump -i
9058 The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
9059 These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
9060 object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
9061 format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
9062 it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
9063 associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
9064 object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
9065 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9066 list all the formats available for your configuration.
9067
9068 @cindex BFD requirements
9069 @cindex requirements for BFD
9070 As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9071 several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9072 BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9073 formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9074 been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9075 BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9076 may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9077
9078 One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9079 mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
9080 useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9081 conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9082
9083 @menu
9084 * BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
9085 @end menu
9086
9087 @node BFD outline
9088 @section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
9089 @cindex opening object files
9090 @include bfdsumm.texi
9091 @end ifclear
9092
9093 @node Reporting Bugs
9094 @chapter Reporting Bugs
9095 @cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9096 @cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
9097
9098 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
9099
9100 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9101 it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
9102 to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
9103 work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
9104 @command{ld}.
9105
9106 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9107 information that enables us to fix the bug.
9108
9109 @menu
9110 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
9111 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
9112 @end menu
9113
9114 @node Bug Criteria
9115 @section Have You Found a Bug?
9116 @cindex bug criteria
9117
9118 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9119
9120 @itemize @bullet
9121 @cindex fatal signal
9122 @cindex linker crash
9123 @cindex crash of linker
9124 @item
9125 If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
9126 @command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
9127
9128 @cindex error on valid input
9129 @item
9130 If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
9131
9132 @cindex invalid input
9133 @item
9134 If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
9135 may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9136 object files are correct.
9137
9138 @item
9139 If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
9140 improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
9141 @end itemize
9142
9143 @node Bug Reporting
9144 @section How to Report Bugs
9145 @cindex bug reports
9146 @cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
9147
9148 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
9149 products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
9150 recommend you contact that organization first.
9151
9152 You can find contact information for many support companies and
9153 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9154 distribution.
9155
9156 @ifset BUGURL
9157 Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
9158 @value{BUGURL}.
9159 @end ifset
9160
9161 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9162 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9163 fact or leave it out, state it!
9164
9165 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9166 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
9167 assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9168 matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9169 the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9170 location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9171 were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9172 into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9173 specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
9174 and the most helpful.
9175
9176 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9177 the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9178 on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
9179
9180 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
9181 bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9182 respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9183 You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
9184
9185 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9186
9187 @itemize @bullet
9188 @item
9189 The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
9190 the @samp{--version} argument.
9191
9192 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
9193 the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
9194
9195 @item
9196 Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
9197 patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9198
9199 @item
9200 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9201 version number.
9202
9203 @item
9204 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
9205 ``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9206
9207 @item
9208 The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9209 observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9210 list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9211 sufficient.
9212
9213 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9214 and then we might not encounter the bug.
9215
9216 @item
9217 A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
9218 bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9219 provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9220 bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9221 state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9222 requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9223 we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9224 attachments are best.
9225
9226 If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9227 @code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9228 object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9229 @code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9230 how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9231
9232 @item
9233 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9234 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9235
9236 Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
9237 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9238 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9239 a chance to make a mistake.
9240
9241 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9242 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
9243 copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
9244 C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9245 and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9246 fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9247 you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9248 any conclusion from our observations.
9249
9250 @item
9251 If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
9252 diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9253 @samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
9254 If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
9255 context, not by line number.
9256
9257 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9258 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9259 @end itemize
9260
9261 Here are some things that are not necessary:
9262
9263 @itemize @bullet
9264 @item
9265 A description of the envelope of the bug.
9266
9267 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9268 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9269 changes will not affect it.
9270
9271 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9272 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9273 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9274 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9275
9276 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9277 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9278 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9279 less time, and so on.
9280
9281 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9282 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9283
9284 @item
9285 A patch for the bug.
9286
9287 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9288 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9289 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9290 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9291
9292 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
9293 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9294 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9295 able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9296 fixed.
9297
9298 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9299 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9300 help us to understand.
9301
9302 @item
9303 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9304
9305 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9306 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9307 @end itemize
9308
9309 @node MRI
9310 @appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9311 @cindex MRI compatibility
9312 To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9313 linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
9314 alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9315 described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9316 simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
9317 @command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
9318 linker commands; these commands are described here.
9319
9320 In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9321 file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9322 features to make use of them.
9323
9324 You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9325 @samp{-c} command-line option.
9326
9327 Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9328 command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9329 blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
9330 MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
9331 issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9332
9333 Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9334
9335 You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9336 lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9337 The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9338
9339 @table @code
9340 @cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9341 @item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9342 @itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9343 Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
9344 the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9345 @code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9346 your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9347 script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9348 commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9349 input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9350 @code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9351
9352 @cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9353 @item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9354 Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9355 in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9356
9357 @var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9358
9359 @cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9360 @item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9361 Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9362 @var{expression} should be a power of two.
9363
9364 @cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9365 @item BASE @var{expression}
9366 Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9367 absolute addresses) in the output file.
9368
9369 @cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9370 @item CHIP @var{expression}
9371 @itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9372 This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9373
9374 @cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9375 @item END
9376 This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9377
9378 @cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9379 @item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9380 Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9381 language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9382
9383 @cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9384 @item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9385 Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9386 @command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9387
9388 The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9389 same line, with no change in its effect.
9390
9391 @cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9392 @item LOAD @var{filename}
9393 @itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9394 Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9395 same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9396 command line.
9397
9398 @cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9399 @item NAME @var{output-name}
9400 @var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9401 MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9402 option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9403
9404 @cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9405 @item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9406 @itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9407 Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9408 order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9409 script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9410 sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9411 file, in the order specified.
9412
9413 @cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9414 @item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9415 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9416 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9417 Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9418 @var{name} used in the linker input files.
9419
9420 @cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9421 @item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9422 @itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9423 @itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9424 You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9425 specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9426 If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9427 @var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9428 @end table
9429
9430 @node GNU Free Documentation License
9431 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9432 @include fdl.texi
9433
9434 @node LD Index
9435 @unnumbered LD Index
9436
9437 @printindex cp
9438
9439 @tex
9440 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
9441 % meantime:
9442 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9443 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9444 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9445 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9446 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9447 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9448 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9449 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9450 \page\colophon
9451 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9452 @end tex
9453
9454 @bye